Beruflich Dokumente
Kultur Dokumente
Return to TOC
HISTORY
Our roots can be traced to the mid-1800s and to the founding father of our company, Frederick J. Grinnell - a time when blacksmiths used their hands to form steel into usable hanger products. Today our state-of-the-art equipment cuts, forms, mills, welds and tests our hanger and support products with just as much pride in quality, but with far greater precision. Were known for the quality of our products, quality that our customers demand and on which they continue to rely to this present day. Our long, successful history has proven our products and validated our latest advances in pipe hanger and support technology. Since April of 2000, Anvil has been our new name, but our record of design excellence, quality products, selection and customer support afford us our position as the world leader in pipe hangers and supports.
Commitment
The employees of Anvil are committed to produce and service a package of quality Hanger products unmatched by any other single manufacturer. Our commitment extends to the full requirements of the ISO Customer Satisfaction Standard and is constantly monitored to assure we achieve our goals. Our U.S. made Pipe Hangers and Supports can be found the world over in applications ranging from power plants to refining to manufacturing to on-board ships. Simply, Anvil is the most experienced manufacturer of Pipe Hanger and Supports in America. For service, capability and quality, Anvil should be your first choice for all of your Pipe Support requirements.
Our hangers and supports can be found all over the world!
Return to TOC
ENGINEERED HANGERS PRODUCT LINE Variable Springs Constant Supports Hydraulic Snubbers Vibration Sway Braces Sway Struts Limit Stops We also provide: Special Fabrication/ Miscellaneous Structural Steel Fabrication Special Design Products Per Customer Specifications Domestic Manufactured Product Line ANVIL MARKETS Nuclear Power Fossil Power Co-generation Petro Chemical Refinery Pulp & Paper Marine Waste Water, Water Treatment Industrial Mechanical HVAC/ Plumbing Fire Protection DESIGN SERVICES Either on or off-site, Anvil Design Services helps you maximize the efficiency of your pipe support systems. These services include: Pipe Hanger Design & Engineering Manual & ComputerAided Drafting System Analysis Pipe Stress Analysis Product Qualification Testing (environmental static and cycling loads, flow and leak) Supervision of Client Design Personnel
MANUFACTURING EXCELLENCE
Anvil Pipe Hangers and Supports are manufactured in three primary U.S. locations: North Kingstown, Rhode Island; Henderson, Tennessee and Columbia, Pennsylvania, each with its own unique capabilities. At 122,000 square feet, our Pipe Support design and fabrication facility in North Kingstown, Rhode Island is the industry leader in the Engineered Hanger Market for experience and in house manufacturing capability. Our equipment can accommodate any project since we have the capability to machine, saw and flame cut up to 3" thick carbon and alloy steel and plasma cut stainless steel. We thread rod through 4" in diameter and we hot form small to large diameter clamps. Our facility also has complete in house blasting and painting capability and we perform complete in house Non-Destructive Examination including X-Ray, PT, UT and Magnetic Particle testing. This expertise is supported by our total quality programs including our ASME NPT and "NS" Nuclear Certificates of Authorization, ISO 9001 certification and audited by NUPIC. Our manufacturing facility in Henderson, Tennessee has over 175,000 square feet of manufacturing capability dedicated to producing a complete line of commercial, light industrial and industrial Pipe Hangers and Supports. These include clamps, braces, inserts, rods and attachments, slides and guides to exacting industry standards and certified to ISO 9000 quality. The products manufactured in Henderson are designed for use in a wide variety of rigid Pipe Hanger or Support applications, in markets including fire protection, electrical, water and waste water treatment, petrochemical, seismic, industrial and commercial. Special fabrication is available from our Henderson facility as well. At our Columbia, Pennsylvania Foundry, where we manufacture malleable fittings, cast iron fittings and our Gruvlok products, we also manufacture our malleable and ductile iron Hanger Products such as beam clamps, numerous types of pipe clamps, concrete inserts, ceiling flanges and different types of rod attachments. With over 600,000 square feet of manufacturing floor space under roof, our foundry has an annual pouring capacity of 100,000 tons. Columbia is ISO 9000 certified and is a quality manufacturer of malleable, ductile and cast iron products. In addition to these three facilities Anvil also has Hanger fabrication facilities in Houston, Texas to service the Gulf Coast Engineered Hanger requirements, as well as Toronto, Canada to meet the needs of the Canadian Hanger markets.
Customer Service
With five key stocking locations throughout North America, you can count on getting all of the product you need - when you need it. When you have installation questions our solid customer service personnel are there to answer all of you questions, backed by our designers or engineers we are there for you - on site if needed.
Return to TOC
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Copper Tubing Hangers through Straps
Copper Tubing Hangers
Fig. CT-69 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Fig. CT-65 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Fig. CT-99 & Fig. CT-99C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Fig. CT-109 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Fig. CT-138R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Fig. CT-121 & Fig. CT-121C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Fig. CT-128R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Fig. CT-255 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20
Brackets
Fig. 202 Fig. 206 Fig. 207 Fig. 194 Fig. 195 Fig. 199 ................................................ ................................................ ................................................ ................................................ ................................................ ................................................ 63 64 64 65 66 67 68 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 80 81 81 81 82 82 82 83 84 84 85 85 86 87 88 88 89 90 91 91 92 93 93 94 95 95
Pipe Rings
Fig. 108 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Fig. 138R. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Fig. 104 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Fig. 97 & Fig. 97C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Fig. 69 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
Clevis
Fig. 67 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Fig. 65 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Fig. 260 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Fig. 300 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Fig. 590 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31
Hanger Rods
Fig. 142 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 146 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 140 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 253 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 248 & Fig. 248L . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 278 & Fig. 278L. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 248X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 278X . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 148 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Rod Attachments
Fig. 135, Fig. 135E & Fig. 135R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 136 & Fig. 136R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 114 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 110R . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 157 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 299 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 233 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 230 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 290 & Fig. 290L. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .
Socket Clamps
Fig. 595 & Fig. 594 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Fig. 600 & Fig. 599 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45
Beam Clamps
Fig. 86, Fig. 87 & Fig. 88 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Fig. 95 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Fig. 89 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Fig. 89X. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Fig. 92 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Fig. 93 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Fig. 94 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Fig. 227 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Fig. 217 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Fig. 14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Fig. 133 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Fig. 134 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Fig. 218 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Fig. 228 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Fig. 292 & Fig. 292 L . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57
Straps
Fig. 126 Fig. 262 Fig. 243 Fig. 244 ................................................ ................................................ ................................................ ................................................
Structural Attachments
Fig. 55 & Fig. 55L . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Fig. 54 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59 Fig. 66 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 Fig. 60 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61 Fig. 112 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Fig. 113 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62
PH 4
Return to TOC
TABLE OF CONTENTS
Trapeze
Fig. 46 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Fig. 45 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104 Fig. 50 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105
Pipe Rolls
Fig. 177 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 171 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 178 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 181 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 175 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 277 & Fig. 277S. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 271 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Fig. 274, Fig. 274P & Fig. 275 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 113 114 115 116 117 118 119
Spring Hangers
Fig. 247 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 131 Fig. 82, B-268, 98, Triple & Quadruple Springs . . . . . . . . . . . . .132 - 133 Spring Hanger Size & Series Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .134 - 135 Check List. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type B & C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type D & E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type F . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 140 Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type G. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 141 Fig. 82, Fig. C-82 Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143 Fig. 98, Fig. C-98 Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 145 Triple Spring, Triple Spring-CR Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 147 Quadruple Spring, Quadruple Spring-CR Series . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 149
Constant Supports
Model R 80-V, C-80-V Vertical . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .150 - 153 Total Travel & Selection Chart. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .154 - 157 Fig. 80-V Type A . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 158 Fig. 80-V Type B . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 159 Fig. 80-V Type C . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 160 Fig. 80-V Type D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 161 Fig. 80-V Type E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 162 Fig. 80-V Type G . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 163 Fig. 80-V Type A, B & C Size 84-110 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 164
Anvil reserves the right to make specication changes without notice. While every effort has been made to assure the accuracy of information contained in this catalog at the time of publication, we cannot accept responsibility for inaccuracies resulting from undetected errors or omissions. The blue color used in the artwork indicates items that are not included with that individual part. Rod load ratings shown in this catalog are based upon the pending edition of the MSS-SP-58.
PH 5
Return to TOC
Fig. CT-138R
Extension Split Tubing Clamp
PH-15
PH-17
PH-17
PH-14
PH-16
Fig. CT-128R
Rod Threaded Ceiling Flange
PH-18
PH-19
Fig. CT-255
Copper Tubing Alignment Guide
PH-20
Pipe Rings
Fig. 104
Adjustable Swivel Ring, Split Ring Type
Fig. 69
Adjustable Swivel Ring
PH-23
PH-22
PH-24
PH-25
PH-26
Clevis
Fig. 67
Pipe or Conduit Hanger
Fig. 65
Light Duty Adjustable Clevis
Fig. 260
Adjustable Clevis Hanger
PH-27
PH-28
PH-29
PH-31
PH-30
PH 6
Return to TOC
Fig. 261
Extension Pipe or Riser Clamp
Fig. 40
Riser Clamp Standard
Fig. 103
Offset Pipe Clamp
PH-32
PH-33
PH-34
Fig. 100
Extended Pipe Clamp
Fig. 212
Medium Pipe Clamp
PH-35
PH-36
Fig. 212FP
Earthquake Bracing Clamp
Fig. 216
Heavy Pipe Clamp
Fig. 295
Double Bolt Pipe Clamp
Fig. 295A
Alloy Double Bolt Pipe Clamp
Fig. 295H
Heavy Duty Double Bolt Pipe Clamp
Fig. 224
Alloy Steel Pipe Clamp
Fig. 246
Heavy Duty Alloy Steel Pipe Clamp
PH-37
PH-38
PH-39
PH-40
PH-41
PH-42
PH-43
Socket Clamps
PH-44
PH-45
Beam Clamps
Fig. 95
C-Clamp with Locknut
Fig. 89
Retaining Clip
Fig. 93
Universal C-type Clamp
PH-48
PH-46
PH-47
PH-49
PH-48
PH-50
PH 7
Return to TOC
Fig. 94
Wide Throat Top Beam C-Clamp
Fig. 227
Top Beam Clamp
Fig. 217
Adjustable Side Beam Clamp
Fig. 14
Adjustable Side Beam Clamp
Fig. 133
Standard Duty Beam Clamp
Fig. 134
Heavy Duty Beam Clamp
PH-52
PH-53
PH-53
PH-51
PH-54
PH-54
Fig. 218
Malleable Beam Clamp Without Extension Piece
Fig. 228
Universal Forged Steel Beam Clamp
PH-55
PH-56
PH-57
Structural Attachments
Fig. 54
Two Hole Welding Beam Lug
Fig: 66
Welded Beam Attachment
Fig. 60
Steel Washer Plate
PH-61
PH-58
PH-59
PH-60
PH-62
Brackets
Fig. 202
Iron Side Beam Bracket
Fig. 206
Steel Side Beam Bracket
Fig. 207
Threaded Steel Side Beam Bracket
Fig. 194
Light Welded Steel Bracket
Fig. 195
Medium Welded Steel Bracket
Fig. 199
Heavy Welded Steel Bracket
PH-63
PH-64
PH-64
PH-65
PH-66
PH-67
PH 8
Return to TOC
Fig. 395
Cast Iron Ceiling Plate
Fig. 153
Pipe Hanger Flange
PH-68
PH-69
PH-68
PH-70
Fig. 281
Wedge Type Concrete Insert
Fig. 285
Light Weight Concrete Insert
Fig. 286
Iron Cross Design
Fig. 284
Metal Deck Hanger
PH-71
PH-72
PH-73
PH-74
PH-75
PH-76
Fig. 47
Concrete Single Lug Plate
Fig. 52
Concrete Rod Attachment Plate
PH-77
PH-78
PH-79
Hanger Rods
Fig. 142
Coach Screw Rods Machine Threaded on Opposite End
Fig. 146
Continuous Thread
PH-80
PH-80
PH-81
Fig. 248
Threads Eye Rod Not Welded
Fig. 114
Turnbuckle Adjuster
PH-81
PH-82
Fig. 148
Rod W/Eye End
PH-84
PH-84
PH-85
PH-82
PH-82
PH-83
PH 9
Return to TOC
Fig. 110R
Socket, Rod Threaded
Fig. 299
Forged Steel Clevis
PH-85
Fig. 233
Turnbuckle
Fig. 230
Turnbuckle
Fig. 291
Clevis Pin With Cotters
PH-86
PH-87
PH-88
PH-88
PH-89
PH-90
U-Bolts
PH-93
PH-92
Straps
Fig. 126
One-Hole Clamp
Fig. 262
Strap Short
Fig. 243
Pipe Strap
Fig. 244
Pipe Strap
PH-94
PH-94
PH-95
PH-95
Pipe Supports
Fig. 63 Fig. 62
Type A, B and C Pipe Stanchion Type A, B and C Pipe Stanchion
Fig. 192
Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support
Fig. 191
Adjustable Pipe Stanchion Saddle With U-Bolt
PH-97
PH-96
PH-98
PH-98
PH 10
Return to TOC
Fig. 265
Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support
Fig. 259
Pipe Saddle Support
PH-99
PH-100
PH-101
PH-102
Trapeze
Fig. 46
Universal Trapeze Assembly
Fig. 45
Channel Assembly
Fig. 50
Equal Leg Angle for Trapeze Assembly
PH-103
PH-104
PH-105
Fig. 167
Insulation Protection Shield
Fig. 168
Rib-Lok Shield
PH-106
PH-107
Pipe Rolls
Fig. 171
Pipe Roll Single Pipe Roll
Fig. 178
Spring Cushion Hanger
Fig. 181
Adjustable Steel Yoke Pipe Roll
PH-112
PH-114
PH-115
PH 11
Return to TOC
Fig. 175
Roller Chair
Fig. 271
Complete Pipe Roll Stand
PH-116
PH-117
PH-118
PH-119
Fig. 255
Pipe Alignment Guide PH-120 - PH-121
Fig. 256
Pipe Alignment Guide PH-122 - PH-123
PH-125
PH-125
Fig. 439
Structural H Slide Assembly, Complete
Fig. 432
Special Clamp
Fig. 212
Medium Pipe Clamp
PH-127
PH-129
PH-130
Spring Hangers
PH-131
PH-144 - PH-145 Triple Spring, Triple Spring-CR, PH-146 - PH-147 Quadruple Spring, Quadruple Spring-CR, PH-148 - PH-149
PH 12
Return to TOC
Fig. 170
Horizontal Traveler
PH-174
Fig. 210
Replacement Strut
PH-178 - PH-179
PH-182
PH-183
Fig. 312
Tapered Pin
PH-192
PH 13
Return to TOC
Features: Threads are countersunk so that they cannot become burred or damaged. Knurled swivel nut provides vertical adjustment after piping is in place. Captured swivel nut will not fall off. Ordering: Specify nominal tube size, gure number, name and nish.
38"
Tube Size
1 2 3 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4
PH 14
v v
C L
v v F C B v
Fig. CT-69: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load Weight
0.09 0.09 300 0. 10 0.10 0.10 0. 11 525 650 0.25 0. 27 0.48
B
2 7 16 2 5 16 2 1 2 2 11 16 3 7 16 3 13 16 4 1 4 4 3 8
C
1 1 2 1 3 8 1 7 16 1 9 16 1 13 16 2 1 2 2 15 16 3 3 8 3 1 2
F
1 3 16
15 16
1 1 1 2 1 11 16 1 7 8 1 1 2
Fig. CT-65
Size Range: 1 2 " through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Copper plated, also available in yellow dichromate and plastic coated. Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated, stationary copper tube. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication WW-H-171-E (Type 12). Installation:
(1) Adjustment may be made either before or after tubing is in place without temporary support of pipe. (2) Hanger rod and nuts may be locked into position after adjustment by use of the upper nut.
Features: Provides for adjustment up to 17 8 ". Ordering: Specify nominal tube size, gure number, name and nish
v v v v F v B E C v C L
Tube Size
1 2 3 4
Max Load
150
Weight
0.09 0.10 0.17 0.18
Fig. CT-65: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A B
1 1 2 1 11 16
3 8
D
1 7 16 1 9 16 1 5 8 1 3 4 1 15 16 2 5 16 2 3 4 3 3 1 4
Adjustment F
5 16 7 16 1 2 5 8 13 16
1 7 8 2 5 32 2 17 32 3 11 32 3 27 32
1 3 16 1 5 16 1 5 8 1 7 8
4 15 32 4 31 32
PH 15
Return to TOC
Fig. CT-99: Adjustable Tubing Ring Size Range: 1 2 " through 4" Material: Carbon steel ring and malleable iron adjusting nut. Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary copper tube. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 9) WW-H-171-E (Type 9)
and MSS-SP-69 (Type 9).
Installation: Full load carrying capacity is reached when the rod is screwed to the bottom
of the opening in the nut.
Features: Large sight hole provides means of assuring thread engagement. Sized for copper tubing. Greater vertical adjustability. Nut may be attached to rod before pipe is picked up in band and snapped into position. Competitively priced. Ordering: Specify nominal tube size, gure number, name. Fig. CT-99C: Coated Adjustable Tubing Ring Size Range: 1 2 " through 4" Material: Carbon steel ring and malleable iron adjusting nut Finish: Copper plated with the band plastic coated. Features: Eliminates possibility of galvanic action between
hanger and copper tubing.
v v B E v C v
Fig. CT-99, Fig. CT-99C: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Tube Size
1 2 3 4
Max Load
Weight
0.14 0.15
Rod Size A
B
2 1 2 2 5 8
C
1 3 4 1 7 8 2 2 1 4 2 3 8 2 9 16 3 3 3 8 4 3 16
Adjustment E
1 7 16
1 1 1 4
400
3 8
2 3 4 3 3 1 8 3 5 16 3 7 8
PH 16
C L
1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 650
1 9 16 1 1 2 1 11 16 1 13 16 2 1 8
0.36 0.41
1 2
4 1 4 5 1 16
Fig. CT-109
Size Range: 12" through 3" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary copper tube.
May be used with rod socket Fig. 110R or turnbuckle adjuster Fig. 114
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 11) WW-H-171-E (Type 11) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 11). Service: The split tubing ring Fig. CT-109 is used for suspension of tubing on many
installations where it is necessary to specify universally adaptable parts. May be used with rod socket Fig. 110R or turnbuckle adjuster Fig. 114.
Weight
0.07 0.09 0.12
C
3 4 7 8
Bolt Size
#10 x 3 4
3 4
1
v
38"
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 11 16 1 15 16 1 1 4
C L
1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3
300
1 4
x 1
450
0.35 0.46
1 4
x 1 1 4
Fig. CT-138R
Size Range: 12" through 2" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary copper tube. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 12)
WW-H-171-E (Type 25) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 12).
Installation: Permanent installation of clamp may be made before the tubing is placed in position. Final installation is attained by swinging the lower portion of the hinged clamp up
under the tubing and inserting a single screw securely.
Features: Hinged design provides for economical installation. Designed to provide a tight t on copper tubing. Ordering: Specify nominal tube size, gure number, name.
v v
C L v
Fig. CT-138R: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Tube Size
1 2 3 4
Max Load
Weight
0.10 0.12
B
3 4 7 8
1
v
180
1 1 1 8 1 1 4 1 9 16
1 1 4 1 1 2 2
PH 17
Return to TOC
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 8) WW-H-171-E (Type 8) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 8). Service: For support and steadying of copper tubing risers. Installation: Clamp is tted and bolted preferably below a coupling
or tting on the tubing. Do not over tighten bolts. Fig. CT-121: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Tube Size
1 2 3 4
Features: Rounded ears provide greater safety for personnel. Ordering: Specify tube size, gure number, name.
Max Load
75 120
Weight
0.52 0.56 0.94 0.98
L
6 1 2 7 9 3 8 9 5 8 10 10 3 8 11 11 1 2 12 13
Stock Width
1
Bolt Size
5 16
1
C C L v v v v
1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 300 150
1 1 4
3 8
B L
3 1 2 4
1 1 2
1 2
Fig. CT-121C
Size Range: 1 2 " through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Copper plated with formed portion plastic coated. Also
available in yellow dichromate.
Max Load
75
Weight
0.52 0.56
L
6 1 2 7 9 3 8 9 5 8 10 10 3 8 11 11 1 2 12 13
Stock Width
1
Bolt Size
5 16
C C L v v v v
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2
120
0.94 0.98
150
1 1 4
3 8
B L
2 1 2 3 300 3 1 2 4
1.90 2.60
1 1 2
1 2
PH 18
Fig. CT-128R
Size Range: 38" through 12" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Copper plated Service: Recommended for attachment to wood beams or ceiling. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name.
316"
2 1 4 "
v A 3516" v v
1 2 "
v
3 8
1 3 8 " v
v v
v v
Fig. CT-128R: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A Screws Weight Quantity
0.16 2
Size No.
12
1 2
PH 19
Return to TOC
Note: Spider attachments to tube must be properly located during installation to insure that a minimum of one-half the spider width remains within the length of the outer housing for all conditions of operation. If larger travels are required, special guides can be furnished to special order. How to size: Size by nominal tube size and insulation thickness in
accordance with the selection table. Tube Size (in)
1" to 4"
L (in)
4
Maximum Movement
4
v
v
v
v
C L
C L
v D
v
PIPE
v
PIPE
v
H DIA 4 HOLES E
J INSULATION THICKNESS
H DIA 4 HOLES
J INSULATION THICKNESS
112
1 2 -1 1 2
2
1 2 -1 1 2
212
1 2
3
1-1 1 2 2-3 1 2 4
4
1-2 1 2 3-4
W
8 13 16 10 1 3 1 6 13 5 1 6 15 7 8
B
6 3 4 8 3 4 11 1 4 13 3 8
C
7 7 8 9 7 8 12 7 1 6 14 1 3 1 6
D
4 5 16 5 5 16 6 5 8 7 15 16
E
6 3 4 7 3 8 7 7 8 9 3 4
21/2 4
&
3 4
2-4
2-4
2-3 1 2 4
1-2 1 2 3-4
PH 20
v v
v v v
21/2 4
5 8
1 4
3 4
5 16
Notes
Copper Tubing Hangers
PH 21
Return to TOC
PIPE RINGS
Fig. 108
Size Range: 3 8 " through 8" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary pipe lines or
conduit. May be used with rod socket Fig. 110R or turnbuckle adjuster Fig. 114.
Maximum Temperature: 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 11)
WW-H-171-E (Type 11) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 11).
Features: Permits installation before or after pipe is in place. Provides economical installation. Permits use of universally adaptable parts. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name.
Figure 108: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 8 1 2
Max Load
200
Weight
0.06 0.09 0.11 0.13
C
3 4 15 16
Bolt Size
#10 x 7 8
PH 22
C L
3 4
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 9 16 1 11 16 2 1 16 2 1 4 2 3 4 3 1 8 3 5 8 4 1 2 5 7 16 6 3 8
1 4
x 1
0.18 0.26 0.33 0.44 0.63 0.81 0.97 1.50 2.60 5.20
1 4
x 1 1 4
3 8
x2
1 2
x 2
Return to TOC
PIPE RINGS
Extension Split Pipe Clamp
Features: Rapid installation assured by hinged design and single closure screw. When used with nipple this clamp is particularly adaptive for use on
refrigeration or compressor piping subject to vibration.
Interior design provides rm grip on pipe. Inside of ring tapered to prevent entrapment of condensed moisture. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish
Fig. 138R
A v
B C L
Fig. 138R: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 8 1 2
Max Load
Weight
0.10 0.13 0.14
Rod Size A
B
13 16 7 8
Fig. 138R
3 4
1
3 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3
180
1 1 8 1 5 16 1 7 16 1 11 16
300
0.60 0.74
1 2
2 1 8 2 7 16
PH 23
Pipe Rings
Return to TOC
PIPE RINGS
Fig. 104 Adjustable Swivel Ring, Split Ring Type
Size Range: 3 4 " through 8" Material: Malleable iron, carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 6)
WW-H-171-E (Type 6) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 6).
Hanger may be installed prior to suspension of pipe. Off-center hinge provides seating for pipe during installation. Wedge-type locking pin is inseparably cast into hinged section,
sizes 212" and larger.
v v
C E B
v v
v
C L
Fig. 104: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 4
v
v
Max Load
Weight
0.31 0.32
Rod Size A
C
2 3 8 2 1 4 2 3 16 2 5 16 2 1 2 2 5 8 3 9 16 3 5 8 4 5 16 4 7 8
2 7 8
3 8
3 3 1 8 3 1 2 3 15 16 4 3 8 5 13 16 6 3 8 7 5 8 9 1 8
1 2
5 8 3 4 7 8
PH 24
D
3 7 16 3 9 16 3 7 8 4 1 8 4 11 16 5 3 8 6 1 8 8 1 16 9 3 16 10 1 5 1 6 13 1 2
E
1 15 16 1 3 4 1 11 16 1 13 16 1 7 8 2 2 7 8 2 15 16 3 1 2 3 7 8
Return to TOC
PIPE RINGS
Adjustable Pipe Ring
Installation: Full load rating is obtained when rod is screwed to the bottom
of the opening in the nut.
Features: Large sight hole provides means of ascertaining proper thread engagement. Design of band provides greater load carrying capacity. Nut may be attached to rod before pipe is picked up in band and
snapped into position.
Greater vertical adjustability. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish
v v B E v C v
Fig. 97, Fig. 97C: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
1 2 3 4
Max Load
Weight
0.14 0.15
Rod Size A
B
2 1 2 2 5 8
C
1 3 4 1 7 8 2 2 1 4 2 3 8 2 9 16 3 3 3 8 4 5 16
Adjustment E
C L
1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4
400
3 8
2 3 4 3 3 1 8 3 5 16
1 3 8
650 1,300
1 2
3 7 8 4 1 4 5 7 16
1 9 16 1 5 8 2 1 16
5 8
PH 25
Pipe Rings
Return to TOC
PIPE RINGS
Fig. 69 Adjustable Swivel Ring, Tapped Per NFPA Standards
Size Range: 1 2 " through 8" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of non-insulated stationary pipe line. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 10)
WW-H-171-E (Type 10) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 10). UL and FM Approved (Sizes 3/4" - 8").
Features: Threads are countersunk so that they cannot become burred or damaged. Knurled swivel nut provides vertical adjustment after piping is in place. Captured swivel nut in the 1 2 " through 3" sizes. Ordering: Specify size, gure number and name.
A v v F v v C B
v
C L
Pipe Size
1 2 3 4
Max Load
PH 26
Rod Size A
B
2 1 4 2 5 16 2 7 16 2 5 8 2 3 4 3 1 4 4 4 3 8 4 11 16 5 5 16 6 7 16 8
C
1 3 8 1 7 16 1 9 16 1 3 4 1 7 8 2 3 8 2 3 4 3 1 8 3 13 16 4 3 8 5 1 2 7
7 8
1 1 8 1 5 16 1 3 8 1 9 16 2 3 16 2 11 16
Return to TOC
CLEVIS
Pipe or Conduit Hanger
Fig. 67
Size Range: 1 2 " through 6" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: Can be suspended by hanger rod or attached to wall. T slot in
hanger permits side bolt to be installed after installation and setting of pipe.
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 5) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 5). Components: Strap and bolt with nut assembled. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name. Clevis Hangers
C L Alternate Installation Bolt/Screw to Vertical Support
v v v
vE
v
v
v
D
B G
F
C
C L
Fig. 67: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
1 2 3 4
Load Rating
Weight
0.21 0.22
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6
400
500
0.78 0.84
550 600
v v
Rod Size A
B
2 5 8 2 7 8
D
1 3 4 1 7 8
F
1 1 2 1 11 16
G
1 15 16 2 1 8 2 5 16 2 5 8 2 7 8 3 1 16 3 5 8 4 1 16 4 3 8 5 3 16 5 3 4 6 5 8
3 8
2 15 16 3 1 4 3 9 16 3 11 16 4 7 16
1 4
1 15 16 2 2 3 16 2 1 8 2 7 16 2 9 16
7 16
1 13 16 2 1 16 2 7 16 2 9 16 3 3 16 3 1 2
1 2
4 13 16 5 1 8
3 8
2 5 8 3 3 16 3 1 4 3 9 16
5 8
6 1 8 6 3 4 7 3 4
9 16
3 3 4 4 5 8 5 1 16 5 13 16
3 4
PH 27
Return to TOC
CLEVIS
Fig. 65
Size Range: 3 8 " through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Epoxy coated Service: Recommended for suspension of stationary pipe or conduit. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication WW-H-171-E (Type 12).
UL and FM Approved (Sizes 21/2" through 4" galvanized only).
Installation: Hanger load nut above the clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment is provided, varying with the size of clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Features: An economical attachment for light duty service. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
v v v v F v B E C v C L
Pipe Size
3 8 1 2 3 4
Max Load
150 0.10 0.17 0.18 250 0.21 0.24 0.26 0.48 350 0.55 0.60 400 0.73
1 2 3 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4
PH 28
Rod Size A
B
1 1 2 1 11 16 1 7 8 2 5 32 2 17 32 2 13 16 3 11 32 3 27 32 4 15 32 4 31 32 5 17 32
C
1 27 32 2 3 32 2 13 32 2 13 16 3 3 8 3 13 16 4 17 32 5 9 32 6 7 32 6 31 32 7 25 32
Adjustment F
5 16 7 16 1 2 5 8 13 16 15 16
1 3 16 1 5 16 1 5 8 1 7 8 2 1 8
Return to TOC
CLEVIS
Adjustable Clevis Hanger
Fig. 260
Size Range: 1 2 " through 30" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized, also available plastic or epoxy coated Service: Recommended for the suspension of stationary pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1), WW-H-171-E (Type 1) Installation: Hanger load nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger
performance. When an oversized clevis is used, a pipe spacer should be placed over the clevis bolt as a spacer to assure that the lower U-strap will not move in on the bolt. For ductile iron pipe sizes, see Figure 590.
Adjustment: Vertical adjustment without removing pipe may be made from 3 8 " through 51 8 ",
varying with the size of clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment.
Features: Design has yoke on outside of lower U-strap so yoke cannot slide toward center of bolt,
thus bending of bolt is minimized.
Sizes 5" and up have rod and two nuts instead of bolt and nut; thread length on clevis rod
is such that the thread locks the nuts in place, and threads are not in shear plane.
Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Note: Punched forming holes may be present on certain sizes of this clevis hanger. These holes are
solely for the purpose of manufacturing, and do not effect the structural integrity or load carrying capacities of these hangers. Fig. 260: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in)
A v v v G E v C C L v v B v F
v v
Pipe Size
12 34
Max Load
Span Ft.
Weight
0.34
Rod Size A
B
11116 2116 2516 238 21316 3516 4116
C
218 2916 3 314 21316 412 512 612 7116 71316 81516 1014 121116 1514 171516 19916 22 241516 27916 311316
7* 730 9* 10* 11* 1,350 12* 13* 1,430 1,940 2,000 3,600 3,800 4,200 4,600 4,800 4,800 4,800 6,000 14* 16* 17* 19* 22* 23* 25* 27 28 30 32 33
0.30 0.35 0.40 0.45 0.50 0.85 1.50 1.10 1.75 1.82 3.60 5.00 8.80 11.40 12.40 19.85 22.25 40.33 49.83 70.00 114 1
58 12 38
138 158 11116 218 258 3316 4116 4316 412 5116 534 7316 8716 1018 101116 12 131516 15316 17516
14
118 1516 158 11316 11116 178 11116 2 218 21316 21116 234 31316 378
38 12 12 58 34 78 38
434 5116 5916 6316 61516 838 978 11916 12916 14 151516 17916 191316
312 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
34
78
114
39316 21916 518 24316 "Span" represents the maximum recommended distance between hangers on a continuous and straight run of horizontal standard weight steel pipe lled with water. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hangers does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown above. *Indicates that span represents the maximum span for water lled pipe as given in Table 1 of page PH-207.
PH 29
Clevis Hangers
and MSS-SP-69 (Type 1). UL, FM and ULC Approved (Sizes 3 4 " through 8").
Return to TOC
CLEVIS
Fig. 300
Size Range: 3 4 " through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain, Galvanized or Epoxy coated Service: Recommended for suspension of insulated stationary pipe lines. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1)
WW-H-171-E (Type 1) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 1).
Installation: Hanger load nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment is provided, varying with the size of the clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Features: Designed for 2" of insulation on 3 4 " through 11 2 " pipe and 4" of
insulation on 2" and larger pipe.
When properly installed, clevis bolt is outside the insulation. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
v v G v v E v F v H v v
B C
Pipe Size
3 4
Max Load
PH 30
C L
Rod Size A
B
3 5 8 4 4 7 16 4 3 4 7 7 16 8 7 16 8 5 8 9 3 8 9 7 8 10 5 8 12 3 8 13 3 4 15 1 8
C
4 1 4 4 11 16 5 1 4 5 3 4 8 11 16 9 15 16 10 5 1 6 11 5 8 12 5 8 14 16 3 4 19 3 1 6 21 9 1 6
E
2 7 8 3 1 4 3 5 8 4 1 16 6 1 2 7 1 2 7 9 16 8 3 16 8 3 4 9 3 8 11 12 1 4 13 5 8
Adjustment F
1 2 5 8 7 8
1 4
1 1 16 1 5 8 2 1 3 4 1 15 16 1 3 4 1 7 8 2 2 1 8 2 7 16
1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8
5 8
3 4
7 8
Return to TOC
CLEVIS
Adjustable Clevis for Ductile or Cast Iron Pipe
Fig. 590
Size Range: 4" through 24" ductile or cast iron pipe Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for the suspension of ductile iron or cast iron pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 1)
WW-H-171-E (Type 1) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 1).
Adjustment: Vertical adjustment without removing pipe may be made from 11516" through 3316", varying with the size of the clevis. Tighten upper nut after adjustment. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
v v
v
v F v
B C
E
C L
Fig. 590: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) D.I./C.I. Pipe Size
4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
Max Load
1,430 1,940 2,000 3,600 3,800 4,200 4,600 4,800 4,800 4,800
Weight
1.64 4.26 6.70 9.73 13.64 16.04 24.52 27.45 46.24 57.10
Rod Size A
5 8
B
5 3 4 7 1 8 8 5 8 10 1 8 12 1 1 6 13 1 4
C
8 3 16 10 9 1 6 13 3 1 6 15 1 1 1 6 18 1 1 1 6 20 7 8 22 1 5 1 6 26 5 8 29 1 1 6 33 1 4
E
4 3 4 5 15 16 7 1 2 8 3 4 10 1 1 1 6 11 5 1 6 12 9 1 6 15 3 1 6 16 3 8 18 3 8
F
1 15 16 2 1 4 2 5 16 2 7 8 2 9 16 2 7 16
3 4
7 8
14 1 4 16 7 8
1 1 4
18 1 4 20 5 1 6
3 13 16
PH 31
Clevis Hangers
Installation: Hanger rod nut above clevis must be tightened securely to assure proper hanger performance.
Return to TOC
Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized and Epoxy 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 8)
WW-H-171-E (Type 8) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 8). UL and ULC Approved (Sizes 11/2" - 8").
Installation: Clamp is tted and bolted preferably below a coupling or welded lugs on steel pipe. Bolt torques should be per industry standards (see page PH-212). Clamp is designed for standard steel pipe O.D. and this must be considered in sizing the riser for other types of piping. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
C C L v v
Fig. 261: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 4
Max Load
220
Weight
1.1 1.1 1.6 1.6 1.7 1.9 1.9 2.3 2.4 3.6 4.0 7.6 11.1 16.5 17.7 30.4
L
8 7 8 10 10 1 4 11 1 4 11 3 8 12 7 8 13 3 4 14 3 4 18 1 2 20 1 4 22 3 4 24 26 28 30 36 3 4
B
2 7 8 3 1 8 3 1 2 3 7 8 4 1 4 4 3 4 5 1 2 6 1 2 7 8 9 12 13 3 4 15 3 4 17 1 4 19 3 4 21 3 4 23 3 4 30
Bolt Dia.
B L
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
v
3 8
3 8
1 2
7 16
1 2
1 2
5 8
5 8
2,700
2,900
33.8 35.0
3 4
3 4
3,200
82.0
7 8
PH 32
Return to TOC
Fig. 40
Size Range: 2" through 24" Material: Carbon steel (CS), Alloy (A), or Stainless Steel (SS) Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: 650 F (CS), 950 F (A),
1,000 F (SS)
Service: Riser clamps are used for the support of vertical piping. Load is carried by shear lugs which are welded to the pipe. Shear lugs provided upon request. Local pipe wall stress evaluation available upon request. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication
A-A-1192A (Type 42) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 42).
Ordering: Specify pipe size, material, gure number, name and nish. Note: If greater loads are required, refer to Fig. 40-SD special design
riser clamp.
BOLT/STUD DIA. F C L
v
S v
v
PIPE SPACER
Fig. 290 v
A v E E
G (max) Fig. 40 v v B v v v v v v
C to C
Fig. 40: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
2 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
E
9 10 11 12 13 1 2 15 16 17 18 19 1 2 21 22 1 2
F
1 2 5 8 3 4
G (max)
2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
S
3 4
Spring Assembly
1,800 3,000 4,400 6,000 11,000 15,600 18,000 27,000 18 20 22 24 27 30 32 34 36 39 42 45
7 8
Weight Each
17.5 19.1 29.4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 1 4 1 1 8 1 1 4 1 5 8 1 7 8 2 1 2 1 3 8 2 3 1 2 2 5 8 4 1 4 3 2
7 8
38.5 43.2 56.8 79.2 143.0 184.0 195.0 225.0 281.0 429.0 465.0
1 1 4
1 1 2
8 9 10 11
PH 33
v v v
Return to TOC
Bolt Dia. F C L v B v
HOLE SIZE D
LOAD W v v
Fig. 103: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 4
Max Load
Weight
1.50
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 8
190
420
610 870
PH 34
W
8 3 4 9 1 4 9 3 4 10 11 1 4 11 3 4 12 7 8 13 7 8 15 5 8 16 3 4 18 3 4
B
2 1 2 2 5 8 2 13 16 2 15 16 3 3 16 3 7 16 3 3 4 4 1 4 4 3 4 5 5 16 6 5 16
Bolt Dia. F
7 16
3 8
9 16
1 2
11 16
5 8
Return to TOC
Fig. 100
Size Range: 3 4 " through 8" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For attachment to structure without use of rods. Maximum Temperature: Plain 650 F, Galvanized 450 F Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
1 8"
C L
v F v v
12" W v v
W
5 5 8 5 7 8 6 3 8 6 7 8 7 1 8 8 3 8 8 7 8 10 10 5 8 12 3 8 13 1 2 15 1 2
E
2 7 8 3 1 8 3 5 8 4 1 8 4 3 8 5 1 8 5 5 8 6 3 4 7 3 8 8 5 8 9 3 4 11 3 4
G
3 16
H
4 1 4 4 1 2 5 5 1 2 5 3 4 6 7 8
Weight
1.85 2.20 2.25 2.34 2.39 3.25 3.40 3.58 4.74 5.09 8.23 9.25
x 1
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 8
3 8
3 16
x 1 1 4
1 2
1 4
1 1 4
7 3 8 8 1 4 9 1 8 10 7 8 12 14
1 4
x 1 1 2 x 2
5 8
1 4
PH 35
Return to TOC
Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 4)
WW-H-171-E (Type 4) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 4). UL, FM and ULC Approved (Sizes 3/4" - 8").
Installation: Normally used with weldless eye nut Fig. 290, page PH-89 or eye rod. Features: Clamps tightly to pipe. C F Wide range of sizes. v Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, v
v v
v B
H v
Fig. 212: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
1 2 3 4
Span Ft.
Weight
0.29
B
1 1 1 8 1 7 16 1 9 16 2 1 8 2 1 2 2 13 16 3 3 16 3 7 16 4 3 16 4 7 8 6 7 7 16 8 7 16 9 1 4 10 1 4 11 5 8 12 3 4 15 1 4 19
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
7*
500
0.33 0.35 0.38 0.43 1.10 1.20 1.40 1.50 2.30 2.60 5.40 6.50 13.60 15.20 20.50 22.30 31.60
1 2
9* 10* 11* 12* 13* 14* 16* 17* 19* 22* 23* 20 15 15 12 12
800
1,040
930
5 8
3 4 7 8
1,615
1,440
2,490
2,220
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 5 8 2
3,060
2,730
35.80 53.10
30 9 3,500 3,360 113.90 1 3 4 Clamps may be furnished with square ends. "Span" represents the maximum recommended distance between hangers on a continuous & straight run of horizontal standard weight steel pipe lled with water. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hangers does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown above. For vapor service, the presence of ttings or insulation, and other weights and types of pipe, spans may either increase or decrease. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hanger does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown. *Indicates that span represents the maximum span for water lled pipe as given in Table 1 of page PH-207.
PH 36
D E C L
H
1 17 32 1 21 32 1 31 32 2 3 32 2 3 4 3 1 8 3 7 16 3 13 16 4 3 16 4 15 16 5 3 4 6 7 8 8 9 16 9 9 16 10 5 8 12 1 8 13 14 1 8 16 7 8 21 1 8
D
1 23 32 1 25 32 1 29 32 2 5 32 2 7 32 2 3 4 3 1 4 3 9 16 3 13 16 4 3 8 4 15 16 5 7 8 7 8 9 16 9 9 16 10 5 8 12 1 8 13 14 1 8 16 7 8 21 1 8
5 16
1 2
5 8
3 4
7 8
1 1 1 8 1 1 4
Return to TOC
Fig. 212FP
Size Range: 21 2 " through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For seismic bracing, to be used with Fig. 113 brace tting.
Pipe clamp bolt holes are designed to match holes in brace tting.
Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 4)
WW-H-171-E (Type 4) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 4).
v v E C L D
v B
H v
Fig. 212FP: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load For Service Temp 650 F
2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 1,040 930
Pipe Size
Weight (lbs)
1.20 1.40 1.50 2.20 2.50 5.20 6.30 13.60 15.20
B
2 1 2 2 13 16 3 3 16 3 7 16 4 3 16 4 7 8 6 7 7 16 8 7 16
750 F
5 8
Rod Take-Out E
2 5 8 2 15 16 3 3 16 3 5 8 4 3 16 5 6 1 8 7 7 16 8 7 16
H
3 1 8 3 7 16 3 13 16 4 3 16 4 15 16 5 3 4 6 7 8 8 9 16 9 9 16
D
3 1 4 3 9 16 3 13 16 4 3 8 4 15 16 5 7 8 7 8 9 16 9 9 16
3 4 7 8
1 2
PH 37
Installation: Designed for use with Fig. 113 brace tting, see page PH-62. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish
v v
v v
Return to TOC
Installation: Normally used with welded eye rod or with weldless eye nut
Fig. 290, see page PH-89.
Features: Designed for heavy load up to 750 F Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
v F
v v D E v v C L
Fig. 216: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 28 30 32 34 36 42
750 F
3,005 3,135 4,350 4,340 5,360 7,740 8,135 3.6 5.5 6.3 11.7 13.9 22.3 38.1 46.8 51.4 130.1 163.6 215.2 302.8 365.4 431.7 533.8 575.1 915.7 2 15 16 3 9 16 4 1 8 5 6 1 8 7 9 16 9 9 3 4 10 3 4 14 1 2 16 18 1 2 20 1 2 22 1 2 23 1 2 25 26 1 2 30 4 1 4 7 8 5 1 2 6 5 8 7 5 8 9 1 16 10 7 8 11 7 8 12 7 8 17 1 4 18 3 4 21 1 2 23 1 2 26 27 28 1 2 30 1 4 33 3 4
PH 38
v v v B
Weight
F
3 4 7 8
H
3 13 16 4 11 16 5 1 4 6 3 8 7 1 2 8 15 16 10 5 8 11 5 8 12 5 8 17 1 4 18 3 4 21 1 2 23 1 2 26 27 28 1 2 30 1 4 33 3 4
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 5 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
3 3 1 4
2 2 1 4
2 1 2
3 1 2
2 3 4
Return to TOC
Fig. 295
Size Range: 3 4 " through 36" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of pipe requiring insulation within the limitation
of temperature and loads shown below.
Galvanized 450 F
v v
v B
H v
Fig. 295: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 4
Weight
0.7 0.8 0.8 2.3 2.6 2.7 3.0 6.7 7.0 11.5 13.2 19.8 22.3 37.7 41.4 44.9 57.3 65.9 112.3 150.0 193.3
B
15 16
D
2 7 8 3 3 1 8 4 7 8 5 7 8 6 1 8 6 11 16 7 5 8 8 1 8 9 11 16 10 1 1 1 6 12 13 14 5 1 6 15 5 1 6
750 F
1 1 16 1 1 4 1 13 16 2 1 8 2 5 16 2 3 4 3 3 8 3 15 16 4 3 4 5 3 4 6 7 8 7 7 8 9 1 16 10 1 1 6 11 1 1 6 12 3 8 14 3 8 17 1 2 18 1 2 19 5 8 21 1 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 1 7 16 1 1 16
5 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 28 30 32
1,545
1,380
16 5 1 6 17 5 8 19 5 8 24 1 4 26 1 8 28 31 1 4
34 9,800 248.8 3 1 3 4 36 10,500 257.5 26 22 1 2 32 1 4 28 3 4 Clamps may be furnished with square ends. "Span" represents the maximum recommended distance between hangers on a continuous and straight run of horizontal standard weight steel pipe lled with water. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hangers does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown above. *Indicates that span represents the maximum span for water lled pipe as given in Table 1 of page PH-207. For vapor service, the presence of ttings or insulation, and other weights and types of pipe, spans may either increase or decrease. In all cases, verify that chosen location of hanger does not subject hangers to a load greater than the maximum recommended load shown.
v v v
Features: Accommodates up to 4" thick insulation. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
C L
H
1 3 8
3 8
1 1 2 1 11 16 2 3 8 2 11 16 2 15 16 3 1 2 4 1 2 5 6 1 8 7 1 8 8 1 4 9 1 4 10 1 1 1 6 11 1 1 1 6 12 1 1 1 6 14 16 20 21 1 4 22 5 8 25
5 8
3 4
7 8
1 1 4
1 3 8 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 1 2
PH 39
Return to TOC
Features: Pipe size 4" and above accommodates up to 4" thick insulation. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name. Note: Galvanizing is not recommended for alloy products.
v F
v v
v B
H v
Fig. 295A: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load s For Service Temp 650 F
1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 5,490 4,500 4,995 4,095 3,550 2,910 2,635 2,160 4,300 3,915 2,795 2,060 2,500 2,865 3,240 2,290 2,620 2,970 1,625 1,860 2,100 1,200 1,380 1,565 1,545 1,410 1,000 745
Pipe Size
750 F
s Based on the allowable stresses shown in the ASME Code for Pressure Piping.
PH 40
v v E C L
Weight 1,050 F
2.3 2.6 2.7 3.0 6.7 7.0 11.5 13.2 19.8 22.3 37.7 41.4 44.9 57.3 65.9
B
1 13 16 2 1 8 2 5 16 2 3 4 3 3 8 3 15 16 4 3 4 5 3 4 7 1 16 8 1 16 9 1 16 10 1 1 6 11 1 1 6 12 3 8 14 3 8
D
4 7 8 5 7 8 6 1 8 6 11 16 7 5 8 8 1 8 9 15 16 10 1 5 1 6 12 12 1 5 1 6 14 5 1 6 15 5 1 6
1,000 F
H
2 3 8
5 8
2 11 16 2 15 16 3 1 2 4 1 2 5 6 1 8 7 1 8 8 1 4 9 5 16 10 1 1 1 6 11 1 1 1 6 12 1 1 1 6 14 16
1 1 16
3 4
7 8
1 7 16
1 1 4
16 5 1 6 17 1 2 19 1 2
1 3 8
Return to TOC
Fig 295H
Size Range: 6" through 36" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for suspension of pipe requiring insulation within
the limitation of temperature and loads shown below.
Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 3)
WW-H-171-E (Type 3) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 3).
v v
v B
H v
Fig 295H: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 28 30 32 34 36
750 F
3,125 4,285 4,910 6,250 8,485 8,930 12,325 13,665 14,555 12.0 18.5 30.3 42.0 60.0 80.0 115.0 140.0 190.0 354.0 406.0 555.0 604.0 678.0 4 3 4 6 7 1 4 8 5 8 9 5 8 10 7 8 12 1 2 13 1 2 15 1 2 18 7 8 19 7 8 21 3 4 23 3 8 24 5 8 4 1 2 4 1 4 4 3 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 3 10 1 3 1 6 11 3 8 13 1 8 14 5 1 6 15 1 2 17 1 8 18 1 4 19 3 4 22 5 1 6 31 3 4 32 3 4 36 37 1 2 40 1 4
C L
Weight
F
1 1 1 8 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 1 2 1 3 4 2
H
6 7 1 4 9 10 3 8 11 5 8 13 1 8 14 1 2 16 18 1 2 23 3 8 24 3 8 26 3 4 28 3 8 30 1 8
2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4
PH 41
Features: Accommodates up to 4" thick insulation. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
v v
Return to TOC
Maximum Temperature: 1,050 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 2)
WW-H-171-E (Type 2) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 2).
Installation:
Normally used with welded eye rod Fig. 278, see page PH-82, or weldless eye nut Fig. 290, see page PH-89.
Features: Designed for the support of loads at temperatures up to 1,050 F. Designed to satisfy most critical engineering specications. Yoke has rugged cross sectional area, eliminating high stress conditions. When used on pipe with 4" of insulation the top bolt is outside of the insulation. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name.
F v v H D
v v K
950 F
3,300 5,290 7,910
s Based on the allowable stresses shown in the ASME Code for Pressure Piping. Over tightening of nuts may overstress U-bolts reducing the load rating. Installation tag attached to clamp gives proper nut tightening.
PH 42
C L
v v
Fig. 224: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Weight 1,000 F 1,050 F
2,770 4,440 6,640 1,890 3,030 4,420 4.0 7.5 9.0 15.8 24.3 26.3 31.0 1 15 16 1 7 16 1 1 16 3 7 8 5 7 16 6 11 16 8 3 8 10 1 8 11 1 8 12 1 4
F
7 8
H
1 2 5 8 3 4
K
6 1 2 9 1 8 11 1 8 13 5 8 16 1 8 17 3 8 19 5 8
1 1 1 8 1 1 2
7 8
Return to TOC
Fig. 246
Size Range: 10" through 24" Material: Chrome molybdenum steel except U-bolt which is stainless steel. Service: Recommended for suspension of high temperature pipe requiring
up to 6" of insulation.
Maximum Temperature: 1,075 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 2)
WW-H-171-E (Type 2) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 2).
Features: Designed for the support of heavy loads at high temperatures. Clamp with ller plate will snugly hold pipe of non-standard size. Alloy load distribution strap provided. When used on pipe with 6" of covering, the top bolt is outside of
the insulation.
Ordering: Specify nominal pipe size and exact O.D. of pipe, gure number,
name. Special alloy ller plates will be provided, at an extra charge, when the O.D. of the pipe size is other than standard. Installation instructions are attached to the clamp when the ller plates are required.
F v
v
H
Fig. 246: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
10 12 14 16 18 20 24
Max Load s Used on O.D. Weight* pipe size 950 F 1,000 F 1,050 F 1,075 F
8 3 4 - 10 1 3 1 6 10 7 8 12 1 3 1 6 16,500 14,910 9,940 7,750 12 7 8 - 14 1 1 6 14 1 8 - 16 1 1 6 16 1 8 - 18 1 1 6 18 1 8 20 1 1 6 19,000 18,410 12,270 9,570 13,500 11,780 7,850 6,120 42.0 58.0 63.0 69.0 94.0 104.0
C L
3"
C
2 2 1 4
D
9 1 8 10 3 4 11 1 2 13 1 8 14 1 2 15 3 4
F
1 1 2 1 5 8
H
1
K
15 3 8 17 7 8 19 1 8
M
3 1 4 4
1 1 4 2
21 1 8 24 1 8 26 1 8 4 1 2 6
2 1 2
14,850 11,580 167.0 3 22 20 1 8 - 24 1 1 6 25,000 22,280 18 1 4 2 1 4 1 3 8 30 3 4 s Based on the allowable stresses shown in the ASME Code for Pressure Piping. Over tightening of nuts may overstress U-bolts reducing the load rating. Installation tag attached to clamp gives proper nut tightening. * This weight does not include ller plates required on non-standard pipe sizes
PH 43
Installation: Normally used with welded eye rod Fig. 278, page PH-82 or weldless eye nut Fig. 290, page PH-89.
Return to TOC
SOCKET CLAMPS
Fig. 595 Fig. 594
Size Range: 4" through 24" Material: Two carbon steel half bands and four bolts and nuts. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Clamps ductile or cast iron mechanical joint piping or
mechanical joint or socket joint ttings together to prevent separation or distortion of pipe line under excessive water pressure.
Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe Socket Clamp Washer
Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Socket clamp washer: Two cast iron washers, Fig. 594, are used
with each socket clamp and these must be ordered separately.
C L
D v v F B
PH 44
Pipe Anchor
v
Fig. 595, Fig. 594: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Test Pressure (PSI) Force* On Clamp Weight Fig. 595 Clamp
12.8 14.6 23.6 29.3 40.3 53.9 76.5 94.3 109.8 148.6 1.7 2.7 4.3 5.8 1.1
4,550 9,340 250 16,080 24,180 34,230 120 115 100 75 50 22,200 27,760 23,900 27,500 26,200
Pipe O.D.
5 7 1 8 9 5 16 11 1 2 13 1 2 15 3 4 17 7 8 20 22 1 8 26 3 8
Bolt E
14 5 8 16 7 8 19 1 8 21 3 8 25 1 8 28 1 4 31 3 8 35 1 8 37 3 4 44 1 4
2 2 1 2 3 4 4 1 2 5
9 5 8
5 8
11 7 8 14 1 8 16 5 8 19 5 8 22 3 8 25 3 8 28 1 8 30 1 2 36
5 8
3 4 7 8
3 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
1 1 8
1 1 4 1 3 8
1 1 4
1 1 2
Return to TOC
SOCKET CLAMPS
Socket Clamp for Ductile Iron or Cast Iron Pipe Socket Clamp Washer
Features: An economical method of anchoring joints of socket ttings when used on other than re protection work. Socket Clamps
D Bolt Dia. F Fig. 599: Washer Size T 9 3 4 2
5 8
Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Socket Clamp Washer
Two cast iron washers, Fig. 599, are used with each socket clamp and these must be ordered separately.
E
v
C L
v
12 14 1 4 16 1 2 18 7 8 22 3 8 24 3 4 27 5 8 29 3 4 35 1 4
5 8
3 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
1 1 8
1 1 4 1 3 8
1 1 4
1 1 2
PH 45
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Fig. 86: C-Clamp With Set Screw and Lock Nut Fig. 87: C-Clamp With Set Screw and Fig. 89 Retaining Clip Fig. 88: C-Clamp With Set Screw Only
Size Range: 3 8 " through 3 4 " Material: Malleable iron clamp; hardened steel cup point set screw. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to "W" and "M" beams where thickness of ange Z
(see table page PH-209) does not exceed 0.75". When clamp is used with Fig. 89 retaining clip, ange thickness may not exceed 0.62".
C-Clamp
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 23) WW-H-171-E (Type 23) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 23). UL, FM and ULC Approved (Sizes 3 8 " - 3 4 "). Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69
(See table on page PH-212). The Fig. 88 is only to be used on installations where the clamp cannot become dislodged from the beam.
Fig. 86
Hardened steel cup point set screw for securing to beam ange. Ribbed design of clamp provides added strength. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, length of retaining clip, if desired.
(Add 2" to ange width of beam to arrive at proper length of retaining clip.) If required length is not standard, order next longer standard.
H E
v v
38"
v C Z v v v
34"
Fig. 89X
Fig. 86
A v v
H E
v v
38"
Z v
v
34"
v v
Fig. 89 v
Fig. 87
A v v
PH 46
v v v v v v C
Fig. 86, Fig. 87 and Fig. 88: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4
C
1 3 4 2
E
5 8
H
1 3 8 1 1 2
Max Load s
400 440 500
Weight Fig. 86
0.28 0.31 0.42 0.55
Fig. 88
0.26 0.29 0.40 0.53
3 4
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
C-Clamp With Locknut
Fig. 95
Size Range: 3 8 " through 1 2 " rod Material: Carbon Steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Designed for fastening ange of "W" and "M" beam. Bottom hole tapped
to accommodate hanger rod.
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 23) WW-H-171-E (Type 23) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 23). UL Approved (Sizes 3/8"). FM Approved (Sizes 3/8" - 1/2"). Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69 (See table on page PH-212). Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. Note: If a retaining clip is desired, you may specify either Fig. 89X or Fig. 89.
For length and other ordering information, refer to Fig. 89X and Fig. 89.
Set Screw
v v D B v
Fig. 95: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2
Max Load
230 380
Weight
0.34
Fig. 89
Fig. 89X
3 8 1 2
3 4
2 1 4
2 3 8
0.40
3 8
PH 47
Beam Clamps
v v v v
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Fig. 89
Size Range: 3 8 " through 1 2 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For use with Figs. 86, 87, 88 & 95 in seismic applications. How to size: Specify length of retaining strap based on beam size. Installation: Length of strap should be adequate to allow at least 1" of strap to
be bent over the beam side of the ange opposite the side the beam clamp is mounted on.
Retaining Clip
Ordering: Specify rod size, Figure number, name, length of retaining clip and
nish (Add 2" to ange width of beam to arrive at proper length of retaining clip). If required length is not standard, order next longer standard.
L v v
v
Fig. 89
Fig. 89: Retaining Clip: Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8
B v
D v
Weights B
1 1 1 4 1 3 8
v 34" v
Fig. 89X
Size Range: 3 8 " through 1 2 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For use with Figs. 86, 88, 92, 93, 94 & 95 in seismic applications. Approvals: Complies with MSS-SP-127. How to size: Specify length of retaining strap based on beam size. Installation: Length of strap should be adequate to allow at least 1" of strap to be bent
over the beam side of the ange opposite the side the beam clamp is mounted on.
Ordering: Specify rod size, Fig. no., name, length of retaining clip and nish (Add 2" to ange width of beam to arrive at proper length of retaining clip). If required length is not standard, order next longer standard.
L
14"
T v v v W v
Width W
1 1 1 4
T
0.058 0.070
Weight 6
0.10 0.13
8
0.14 0.17
10
0.17 0.22
14
0.24 0.31
Length L
6, 8, 10, 14
PH 48
v
1 2 5 8 3 4
D
7 16 15 32 11 16
412
0.17 0.22 0.25
8
0.28 0.37 0.43
10
0.35 0.46 00.51
14
0.53 0.63 0.73
Length L
4 1 2 , 8, 10, 14
Retaining Clip
v v
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Universal C-type Clamp (Standard Throat)
Fig. 92
Size Range: 3 8 and 1 2 " Material: Ductile iron, hardened steel cup point set screw and locknut. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for use under roof installations with bar joist type construction, or for
attachment to the top or bottom ange of structural shapes where the vertical hanger rod is required to be offset from the edge of the ange and where the thickness of joist or ange does not exceed 3 4 ".
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 19 & 23) WW-H-171-E (Type 23) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 19 & 23). UL, FM and ULC Approved. How to size: Size of clamp is determined by size of rod to be used. Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69
(See table on page PH-212)
Features: They may be attached to horizontal anges of structural members in either the top beam or
bottom beam positions.
Thru tapping of the body casting permits extended adjustment of the threaded rod. Can be used with Fig 89X retaining clip for seismic applications. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name of clamp and nish.
v v
G v
3 4 "
C v
v
v
D
v
BODY CASTING v
JAM - NUT
v
Fig. 92: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2
C
1 5 16 1 3 8
D
1 9 16 1 13 16
E
9 16 1 2
F
13 16
G
3 8 7 16
H
1 2 23 32
Bottom
250 760 0.34 0.63
1 1 16
PH 49
Beam Clamps
v v
v
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Fig. 93 Universal C-type Clamp (Wide Throat)
Size Range: 3 8 and 1 2 " Material: Malleable/Ductile iron clamp, hardened steel cup point set screw and locknut. Finish: Plain and Galvanized Service: Recommended for use under roof installations with bar joist type constructions, or for
attachment to the top or bottom ange of structural shapes where the vertical hanger rod is required to be offset from the edge of the ange and where the thickness of joist or ange does not exceed 11 4 ".
How to size: Size of clamp is determined by size of rod to be used. Installation: Follow recommended set screw torque values per MSS-SP-69
(See tables on page PH-212)
Features: They may be attached to horizontal anges of structural members in either the
top beam or bottom beam positions.
Thru tapping of the body casting permits extended adjustment of the threaded rod. Wider throat for attaching to ange with up to 114" thickness. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name of clamp and nish.
v v
C E v
v F v
G v 1 1 4 "
v
JAM - NUT
v
Fig. 93: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2
Bottom
250 760 0.41 0.75 1 5 16 1 3 8 2 5 32 2 11 32
9 16 1 2 13 16 3 8 7 16 5 8 13 16
PH 50
v
v
v
v
D BODY CASTING
1 1 16
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Wide Throat Top Beam C-Clamp
Fig. 94
Size Range: 5 8 " and 3 4 " Material: Malleable/Ductile iron body, hardened steel cup point
set screw and locknut.
Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for use under roof installations with bar joist type
construction, or for attachment to the top ange of structural shapes where the vertical hanger rod is required to be offset from the edge of the ange and where the thickness of joists or ange does not exceed 15 16".
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 19) WW-H-171-E (Type 19) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 19). UL and FM Approved. How to size: Size of clamp is determined by size of rod to be used. Installation: Follow maximum recommended set screw torque values
per MSS-SP-69. (See tables on see page PH-212)
B v
v v 15/16 v C v
Fig. 94: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
5 8 3 4
Max Loads s
1,200 1,600 0.66 0.83
3/8
B
1 3 4 1 7 8
C
2 1 4 2 3 8
D
3 4
E
1 1 4 1 3 8
F
1 1 3 16
PH 51
Beam Clamps
Features: Provides clamping to bar joists which are directly under roof installations. Provides for vertical hanger rod installed offset from the edge of the beam ange. Malleable iron body assures full thread engagement of rod. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name of clamp and nish.
v v
v v
v v
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Fig. 227
Material: Carbon steel jaw, hook rod with nut, lock washer
and plain washer.
Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for use on top ange of beam and roof
trusses where the ange thickness does not exceed 0.81".
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 25) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 25). UL and FM approved when used with 3 8 " and 1 2 " rod sizes. How to size: Determine hook rod length by adding gure in column headed "x" to ange width (see table on page PH-209 for ange width). "x" is not indicated as a dimension on drawing. Installation: Slide stamped steel jaw over beam ange and attach
hook rod and eye rod, nally tightening hook rod. Hammer jaw rmly against the underside of the beam to complete installation.
Features: Two jaw sizes t beam anges thickness from 0.25" to 0.81". Clamp rmly holds to beam providing safe and extremely
economical means of supporting small piping from the top ange of steel beams and roof trusses.
Ordering: Specify jaw size, gure number, name, hook rod length. Standard hook rods are furnished in even inch lengths, either length ordered or next longer length.
B v v C A
Fig. 227: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Jaw Size
1 2
v v
Max Load
730 940
Weight v
0.38 0.67
Rod Size A
3 8 1 2
B
3 4
C
5 16 3 8 7 16 1 2
X
2 1 8 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 5 8
1 1 1 8 1 1 4
1 2
5 8 3 4
v Based on 8" hook rod length. Will vary for other hook rod lengths
PH 52
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Adjustable Side Beam Clamp
Fig. 14
Size Range: 3 8 " through 5 8 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for supporting pipe from the bottom ange of beams. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 27)
WW-H-171-E (Type 54) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 27).
Rod Size A
3 8 1 2
Max Load
300 700 1,000
Hole Size A
7 16 9 16 11 16
Weight
1.19
Max.
8 1.67 2.23
5 8
Fig. 217
Size Range: 3 " through 75 8 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: To be used where it is necessary for the hanger rod to run
vertically close to the beams edge, eliminating drilling of holes in structural members.
Components: Top slide, bottom hook, nut and bolt assembled. Design: Can be adjusted to t various beam ange widths and thicknesses Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 25)
and MSS-SP-69 (Type 25).
Fig. 217: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Flange Width Max Flange Thickness Rod Size A Max Load Weight
300
0.80 1.06 1.17 1.28 1.57 1.84 2.05 2.23 3.75 4.19 4.53 5.11
500
700
PH 53
Beam Clamps
212"
v v v
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Fig. 133 Fig. 134
Size Range: 4 " through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Clamp centers the load on beam to prevent distortion Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 21)
WW-H-171-E (Type 21) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 21). Fig. 133 UL and FM Approved when used with 3 8 " and 1 2 " rod. Fig. 134 UL and FM Approved when used with 1 2 " and 5 8 " rod.
Components: Two half-clamps, pipe spacer and bolt with nut assembled. Ordering: Figure number, width of ange, name and nish. Note: Spacer is furnished for use with Fig. 290 weldless eye nuts.
Spacer may be removed for use with Fig 278 eye rods.
Spacer
v B
v
v v Bolt C
PH 54
Fig. 133, 134: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) C Fig. 133 Fig. 134
1 2 3 4
B
1 3 8 2 1 4
Bolt Size
3 8 5 8
Spacer O.D.
11 16
Max Load
1,000 3,000
1 1 16
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Malleable Beam Clamp Without Extension Piece
Fig. 218
Material: Malleable iron jaw, steel tie rod, nuts and washer. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to structural steel.
Use in conjunction with beams where beam widths are from 23 8 " minimum to 7" maximum and ange thickness does not exceed 0.60".
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 30) WW-H-171-E (Type 30) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 30). UL, FM and ULC Approved (Sizes 3/4" - 8" pipe size), when used with the Fig. 157 extension piece (Sizes 3/8" - 7/8"). Installation: The malleable beam clamp Fig. 218 may be used with an eye rod, or Fig. 157 extension piece. Features: Functional design insures proper t for all beam sizes. Tie rod locks clamp in place when nuts are tightened. Ordering and stocking simplied because of one universal size. Design allows hanger rod to swing from vertical providing exibility
at the beam clamp.
Ordering: Specify gure number, name and nish. Note: When used with Fig. 157 see page PH-86 extension piece, an
additional inch or more of vertical adjustment is obtained.
v
v E
Fig. 218: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Width of Beam Flange (in) Max Rod Size A
7 8
Max Load s
Weight 238 3
3 7 16
5
2 15 16
6
2 9 16
7
1 7 8
Bolt Diam
7 16
1,365
2.2
3 1 2
PH 55
Beam Clamps
v v
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Fig. 228 Universal Forged Steel (UFS) Beam Clamp With UFS (Upper) Nut Right-Hand Thread
Material: Forged steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For suspension of heavy loads from beams with
ange widths to 15" and ange thickness to 1.031.
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links) WW-H-171-E (Type 30 & 31) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links). Installation: Fit jaws over edges of lower beam ange and tighten nuts on tie rod to lock clamp in place. Features: Upper nut is tapped to any specied size up to the maximum rod size. Quickly, easily, economically installed. Tie rod insures a tight non-slip t to the beam. Clamps are available, tapped to any specied rod size up to the
maximum rod size.
1 1 8 " v Z v v E v B v v
Z
Ordering: Specify clamp size, gure number, name, rod size and nish. Note: The application of a load to a structural beam by means of a beam
clamp produces a transverse stress, perpendicular to the axis of the beam, in the ange to which the load is applied. Size per load, beam ange width and rod size
Fig. 228: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Clamp Size No.
1 2 3 4 5
v v v
v
5 8 7 8
1 1 16 1 3 8 2 3 8
228 1 228 2
1 1 2
228 3
v B v
v For reference only, order by clamp size. Furnished with links. s Note: Load capacity based on rod sizes shown. For load capacity of other rod sizes see page PH-207 For actual Z dimensions see table on page PH-209
5
1 5 16 2 3 16
6
1 1 8 2 1 16
7
3 4 11 16
8
1 13 16 1 7 8
9
1 1 2 1 9 16
10
1 5 16 3
11
2 11 16
12
2 9 16
13
2 1 4
1 15 16 1 13 16
PH 56
Max Load s
Weight
118"
14
1 15 16
15
1 5 8
Return to TOC
BEAM CLAMPS
Universal Forged Steel (UFS) Beam Clamp With Weldless Eye Nut
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links) WW-H-171-E (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 28 without links; Type 29 with links). Installation: Fit jaws over edges of lower beam ange and
tighten nuts on tie rod to lock clamp in place.
Features: Weldless eye nut provides for horizontal pipe movement without binding. Weldless eye nut is furnished tapped to any specied rod size up to the Tie rod assures a tight non-slip t to the beam. Ordering: Specify clamp size, gure number, name, rod size and nish. Note: The application of a load to a structural beam by means of a beam clamp
produces a transverse stress, perpendicular to the axis of the beam, in the ange to which the load is applied. Fig. 292, Fig. 292L: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in)
v
v
11/8
Max Load s
3,230
Weight
3.9 9.2
Z Max
0.60
B
1 1 4 1 11 16 1 1 2
Z
v
5,900
36.8
4 9 16
v For reference only, order by clamp size. Furnished with links. s Note: Load capacity based on rod sizes shown. For load capacity of other rod sizes see page PH-207 For actual Z dimentions see table on page PH-209
4
4 5 16 4 3 4 6 13 16 7 3 16 8 5 8
5
4 1 16 4 7 16 6 5 8 7 8 7 16
6
3 5 8 4 1 16 6 3 8 6 3 4 8 3 16
7
2 7 8 3 3 8 5 15 16 5 7 8 6 1 4 7 3 4
8
6 5 7 8 6 5 16 7 3 4
9
5 5 16 5 3 8 5 13 16 7 1 4
10
5 4 13 16 5 3 16 6 5 8
11
8 1 8 8 1 2
12
7 3 4 8 1 8
13
7 1 8 7 1 2
14
6 5 8 7
15
6 1 16 6 7 16
A
E
Fig. 292 (w/o Links)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
11,500
35.8
2 1 8
11/8
PH 57
Beam Clamps
v
Return to TOC
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 55 (Short) Fig. 55L (Long)
Size Range: Fig. 55: 1 2 " through 33 4 "
Fig. 55L 1 2 " through 2"
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For attachment to structural steel in conjunction with the
Fig. 299 clevis and with type C variable spring hanger or Type C Constant Support.
Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 57)
WW-H-171-E (Type 57) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 57).
Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, nish and whether short or
long lug is required.
Order Separately: Fig. 291 pin with cotters or bolt and nut
F v v W
FIELD WELD
H v v
R v
Fig. 55, Fig. 55L: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Fig. 55, Fig. 55L Rod Size A*
1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
v
v
FIELD WELD
F
11 16 13 16 15 16
W 650 F 750 F
1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 1,350 2 1 2 2,160 3,230 4,480 3 4 5 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800 49,400 60,100 71,900 9 84,700 98,500
1 4
1 1 4
3 8
1 1 1 8 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 7 8 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 3 8 2 5 8 2 7 8 3 1 8 3 3 8 3 5 8 3 7 8 4 1 8 4 1 2 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4
1 2 5 8
3 4
1 1 2 1 3 4
* Note: Rod size "A" is the assembly rod diameter. Dimension not shown on drawing
PH 58
Return to TOC
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Two Hole Welding Beam Lug
Fig. 54
Size Range: 1 2 " through 21 4 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For single rod suspension of Fig. 81-H, type B and C constant supports. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, nish and H dimension.
H K DIA 2-PLACES
v
W/2
W 2W
W/2
Fig. 54: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A*
1 2 5 8 3 4
Max Load
1,350 2,160 3,230 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300
R v v v
FIELD WELD
2
1.7 1.6 1.6 2.6 5.0
3
2.2 2.2 2.1 3.5 6.5
4
2.6 4.3 7.9
10-18
19-34
35-49
50-63
2W
W/2
1 1 2 2 3
1 1 4
3 8
2 1 2
1 1 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4
1 1 8 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 7 8 2 1 4 2 1 2
1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 3 8 2 5 8
1 1 2 2 2 1 2
1 2 5 8
3 4 5
6 8 10
1 1 2 2 2 1 2
3 4
12
Select H dimension applicable to constant support frame size. v Weight varies with H dimension. * Note: Rod size "A" is the assembly rod diameter. Dimension not shown on drawing
PH 59
Structural Attachments
Return to TOC
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Fig: 66
Size Range: 38" through 312" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to bottom of beams, especially where loads are
considerable and rod sizes are large.
Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 22)
WW-H-171-E (Type 22) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 22).
Installation: If exibility at the beam is desired, use with bolt and eye rod Fig. 278, page PH-82, or with weldless eye nut Fig. 290, page PH-89. If vertical adjustment is desired, use with threaded rod and nut and weld the attachment in an inverted position to the beam. Features: Will accommodate very heavy loads and rod sizes through 31 2 ". Can be installed so as to provide for either exibility or for vertical adjustment. Versatility affords economical stocking and erection. Beam size need not be considered. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. Specify with bolt and nut if required for
1" rod size and smaller. Specify with pin and cotter pins if required for 11/4" rod size and larger.
FIELD WELD FIELD WELD 2" Rod Dia. and Larger are Fabricated v E' H v B/2 v v v v v 134" Rod Dia. and Smaller are Formed v Using Bolt or Pin R and Eye Rod v
E S T v v v v
Fig: 66: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331
E'
H
9 16 11 16 13 16
v
v
FIELD WELD
x 2 1 2 x x 2 1 2 2 3 4 x 4
7 8
1 1 4 1 7 8 2 2 1 2 3 3 3 4 3 1 2
1 4
7 8
1 x 4 1 1 8 x 5 1 3 8 x 5 3 8 1 5 8 x 6 1 7 8 x 6 7 8 2 1 4 x 6 7 8 2 1 2 x 7 3 8 2 3 4 x 7 5 8 3 x 7 3 1 4 x 7 3 1 2 x 7 3 4 3 3 4 x 7 3 4
2 1 2 3 4 5
15 16
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4 4 1 2
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 3 8 2 5 8 2 7 8 3 1 8 3 3 8 3 5 8 3 7 8
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 1 2
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2
3 3 4
5 8
4 1 4
3 4
PH 60
Return to TOC
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Steel Washer Plate
Fig. 60
Size Range: 3 8 " to 33 4 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: A heavy duty washer plate used on top of channels or angles for
supporting pipe with rods or U-bolts.
Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139
Hole Dia. H
1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
5 8 3 4 7 8
3 x 3 x 3 8
1 4 x 4 x 1 2 5 x 5 x 1 2 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 5 x 5 x 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 6 x 6 x 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 7 x 7 x 3 4 3 3 4 4
v H (Hole Dia.)
1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4
3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4
PH 61
Structural Attachments
v
v
v
Return to TOC
STRUCTURAL ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 112 Fig. 113
Size Range: 1 " and 11 4 " Material: Malleable iron bracket and pipe end; hex cap screw and nut. Finish: Plain Service: For bracing piping against sway and seismic movement. Installation: Normally two ttings are used; a Fig. 112 complete attached to one end
of an IPS nipple and a Fig. 113 pipe end only attached to the other end. The brace tting complete connects to the building structure while the pipe end only connects to the pipe attachment. Use with Fig. 212 FP pipe clamp see page PH-37.
Features: Two piece pivoted assembly accommodates any angle to structure. Sight hole in pipe end provides easy means of verifying proper
thread engagement.
R
v
v
v
HOLE SIZE - H
v
v v
C B
v
Fig. 112, Fig. 113: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size A
1 1 1 4
PH 62
SIGHT HOLE
v
T
v
v
v
v
Hole Dia. H
9 16 3 4
R
3 4 7 8
T
1 4 5 16
W
1 1 2 1 3 4
Return to TOC
BRACKETS
Iron Side Beam Bracket
Fig. 202
Size Range: 3 8 " through 5 8 " Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to steel or wooden beams, etc. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 34)
WW-H-171-E (Type 35) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 34). UL, FM and ULC Approved
Features: An economical, practical and adjustable means of securing hangers to beams, etc. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
v G
B v
v
T H
v
E v
v C A A v v v v v v
Fig. 202: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load s Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8
Weight
0.26 0.54 0.94
B
1 3 8 1 13 16 2 3 16
C
5 8 3 4 7 8
D
1 7 16 1 7 8 2 1 8
E
17 32 21 32 7 8
Hole Dia. H
7 16 9 16 3 4
G
7 8
T
1 4 11 32 7 16
1 3 16 1 7 16
PH 63
Brackets
Return to TOC
BRACKETS
Fig. 206
Size Range: 3 8 " through 5 8 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum recommended Load: 2,000 (lbs) when used with bolts. Service: Clip can be fastened to side of joist or wall to support hanger rod. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 34)
WW-H-171-E (Type 35) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 34). UL and FM Approved
v v L v
Fig. 206: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8
Weight (lbs).
0.44 0.43 0.84
Hole Size H
7 16 9 16 11 16
2 1 16 2 1 2
5 8 3 4
1 4 3 8
Fig. 207
Size Range: 3 8 " through 1 2 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to steel or wooden beams, etc. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 34)
WW-H-171-E (Type 35) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 34). UL Approved (with rod size 3 8 " and 1 2 "). FM Approved (with rod size 3 8 " only)
Features: Threaded mounting bracket provides an economical, practical and adjustable means of securing hangers to beams. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
v v 1 3 4
3 8 " 1 2 " 3 8 "
BOLT HOLE
v v
THD. ROD
v v
1516
1 1 4 v
3 8
1 5
2 1 2
1
1 1 8 1 5 8
v v
1 1 4
PH 64
BOLT HOLE
516
v v v
v v
v
3 4
v v v
Fig. 207: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load Rod Size A
3 8
v v v
Bolt Size
3 8 1 2 1 2 5 8
Weight
0.17 0.42
Return to TOC
BRACKETS
Light Welded Steel Bracket
Fig. 194
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for support from below or above bracket. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 31)
WW-H-171-E (Type 32) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 31). FM Approved when used with rod sizes 3 8 " through 7 8 "
Features: Bracket may be installed either in position illustrated or reversed. Ends of bracket are drilled to accept hanger rods up to 3 4 ". Ordering: Specify bracket number, gure number, name and nish. Order separately: Hanger rods, 2 bolts and plate washers.
v v
1316
W C
1"
Max 34"
Additional rod attachments available. Requires: 2 bolts, 2 plate washers (not included)
1"
v D v v
1316
2"
Fig. 194: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Bracket no.
1 2 3 750
Max Load
Weight
3.1 7.7 12.8
W
9 13 19
C
6 1 2 10 1 2 16 1 2
D
5 16 3 8
PH 65
Brackets
v
v v v
v v
Return to TOC
BRACKETS
Fig. 195
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for the support of loads from below or above bracket. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 32)
WW-H-171-E (Type 33) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 32).
Installation: When bolted to a wall, an additional back plate may be required of such thickness and size as to properly distribute the weight over the wall. Size and thickness of the back plate is governed by the load to be carried and the nature and conditions of the wall. Back plates furnished upon request. Features: If supporting pipe by rod, rod can be installed anywhere along the length of the bracket thus providing horizontal adjustment. Ordering: Specify bracket number, gure number, name and nish. Orders for
special brackets are to be accompanied by detailed sketch.
Order Separately: Rod, Fig. 60, bolts, nuts, and back plates for fastening brackets to wall. Specify size and length of rod, bolts size, thickness, and drilling of back plates.
v v
W
3 8 "
F v
G H v v
Fig. 195: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Bracket no.
0 1 2 1,500
Max Load
Weight
17.4 27.3 47.7
W
12 18 24
PH 66
1 1 4 " v
v 2 1 2 " v
Fig. 60
v v
1" GAP
B C
v
1316"
B
18 24 30
C
15 1 2 21 1 2 27 1 2
F
4 5
G
1 1 2 1 3 4 2
H
1 1 2 1 3 4 2
Return to TOC
BRACKETS
Heavy Welded Steel Bracket
Fig. 199
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for the support of loads from above or below bracket. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 33)
WW-H-171-E (Type 34) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 33).
Features: If supporting pipe by rod, rod can be installed at any point along the length of the bracket thus providing horizontal adjustment. Ordering: Specify bracket number, gure number, name. Orders for special brackets are
to be accompanied by detailed sketch.
Order Separately: Rod, Fig. 60, bolts, nuts, and back plates for fastening brackets to
wall. Specify size and length of rod, bolts size, thickness, and drilling of back plates.
1 2 "
D v
1" GAP
B C
B C
Fig. 199: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Bracket No.
0 1 2 3 4 5 3,000
Max Load
Weight
24.3 51.8 65.8 82.1 140.5 166.4
W
12 18 24 30 36 42
B
18 24 30 36 42 50
C
15 1 4 21 3 8 27 1 2 33 1 4 39 46
D
1 3 8 1 7 16 1 1 2 1 5 8 1 1 2
E
2 3 4
F
4 5
3 3 1 2 6 2 1 2 3 1 2 3 1 2
v E v
Fig. 60
v v H v
v v H v
1" GAP
G
1 1 4 2
H
2 2 1 2
K
2 3 4 2 1 2
L
13 16 15 16
1 1 16
PH 67
Brackets
F v v v
v v
v v
Return to TOC
CEILING PLATE
Fig. 127
Size Range: 3 8 " and 1 2 " Material: Plastic Service: Recommended for giving a nished appearance where rod enters ceiling. Installation: Slide plate up rod until ush against ceiling. Features: Highly economical Quickly installed Held rmly to rod by design and friction Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name. (rod not included)
Weight
0.07
Outside Dia.
1 13 16
Depth
1 2
Fig. 395
Size Range: 1 2 " through 8" Material: Cast iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Gives nished appearance where pipe enters ceiling. Installation: Sizes 1 2 " to 4" furnished with one machine screw; sizes 5" to 8",
two machine screws.
Weight
0.21 0.40 0.41 0.51 0.55 0.67 0.93 1.10 1.20 1.40 2.50 3.10 3.30
D - Dia.
2 7 8 3 3 8 3 5 8 4 4 1 4 4 3 4 5 1 2 6 1 8 6 5 8 7 1 8 8 11 16 9 3 4 11 3 4
L
3 4
1 2 3 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
C L C L
2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8
6 1 8
SIZES 2 THRU 4
SIZES 5 THRU 8
1 1 4
PH 68
Return to TOC
CEILING FLANGE
Pipe Threaded, Ceiling Flange
Fig. 128
Size Range: 1 4 " Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to wood beams or ceiling. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
214"
316"
v
14 NPT
3516"
138"
Fig. 128R
Size Range: 3 8 " and 1 2 " Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for attachment to wood beams or ceiling. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish.
316"
214"
v A v v
12"
3516"
138"
Rod Size A
3 8 1 2
Max Load
180
Weight
0.16
PH 69
Ceiling Plates
v v v v v
v
38"
Fig. 128: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size A
1 4
Max Load
180
Weight
0.20
Screws Number of (not included) Pieces Per Carton Quantity Size No.
25 2 12
Return to TOC
CEILING FLANGE
Fig. 153
Size Range: 3 8 " through 3 4 " Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for suspension of pipe lines or conduit from
level ceilings.
Approvals: UL, FM and ULC Approved Installation: Flange size 3 8 " has two holes, sizes 1 2 ", 5 8 ", and 3 4 "
have three holes.
Features: Provides vertical adjustment up to 1". Good appearance. Ordering: specify rod size, gure number and name.
3 8"
Size
Size
H (3 PLACES)
H (2 PLACES)
D E B v v C v v v v
v v
Fig. 153: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4
Max Load
425 1,050 1,220 1,270
Weight
0.4 0.9 1.5 2.2
v v
v
v
v
B
2 7 8 4 4 3 4 5 1 4
C
1 3 8 1 1 2 1 5 8 1 7 8
D
7 8 15 16
E
3 16 1 4 5 16 3 8
x 2 x 2
1 1 1 16
PH 70
Return to TOC
CONCRETE INSERTS
Screw Concrete Insert
Fig. 152
Size Range: 3 8 " through 7 8 " Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe from a concrete ceiling
where no lateral adjustment is required.
Approvals: UL, FM and ULC Approved Features: Eliminates the necessity of drilling holes in wooden forms. Reduced overall height and four slots for nail attachment gives stability
to the insert while the concrete is being poured.
C B
E' v E v
A D v v
Fig. 152: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Max Load s
730 1,130 1,260 2,500
Weight
0.31 0.32 0.37 0.64 0.71
s Based on insert only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
v v
1 1 32 1 7 32 1 5 8
2 1 4
1 2
3 8
1 5 8
5 8 15 16 7 16 3 8
2 1 2
1 1 4
PH 71
Concrete Inserts
Return to TOC
CONCRETE INSERTS
Fig. 282
Size Range: 3 8 " through 7 8 " Material: Malleable iron body and nut Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe, shafting, motors and similar equipment
from a concrete ceiling; especially suitable where rod sizes cannot be readily determined in advance.
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 18) WW-H-171-E (Type 18) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 18). UL, FM and ULC Approved Installation:
1. Nail insert to wooden forms. 2. Where convenient, reinforcing rods may be placed in the opening through the top of the insert, or short lengths of reinforcing rod may be wired to the insert prior to pouring concrete. However, the specied load ratings and approvals are not dependent on the use of any reinforcing rods in contact with the insert. 3. After concrete is poured and wooden forms are removed, place nut in insert and screw rod through nut until rod is rmly against the top of the insert body. The rod should not be forced against the top of the recess thereby placing unnecessary stress at the opening of the insert by the nut.
Features: Cast body prevents concrete seepage. Opening in top of insert provides for use of reinforcing rods up to 7 8 " diameter. Sides of insert
are recessed for reinforcing rods up to 1" diameter.
Low height, broad at bottom and widely separated nail slots minimize displacement during
construction.
The nut, held in place by V-type teeth on both insert and nut, can be raised and moved from side to
side providing for lateral adjustment.
Rod is locked in place by screwing it rmly against the top of the recess. One body size. Ordering: Specify gure number, name, nish and size of nut.
Fig. 282 CB: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8
Adjustment B
Max Load s
730 1,130 1,140 1,140 1,140
Weight
3 3 8
3 1 4 1 7 8
1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
1 11 16
1.5
1 1 8
v
2316
1316
3 8
1.3
v v
A A
PH 72
Nut Only
1 2 5 8 3 4
0.2
7 8 s Based on insert and nut only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
Return to TOC
CONCRETE INSERTS
Wedge Type Concrete Insert
Fig. 281
Size Range: 1 4 " through 7 8 " Material: Carbon steel body; malleable iron nut Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe or conduit from concrete ceiling. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 18)
WW-H-171-E (Type 19) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 18). UL, FM and ULC Approved (Sizes 3/8" - 3/4").
Installation:
1. Nail insert to wooden forms. 2. Where convenient, reinforcing rods may be placed in the opening through the top of the insert, or short lengths of reinforcing rod may be wired to the insert prior to pouring concrete. However, note that the specied load ratings and approvals are not dependent on the use of any reinforcing rods in contact with the insert. 3. After concrete is poured and forms removed, insert screw driver into slot in knockout plate and snap it out. 4. The nut may be put on the rod before inserting in the insert body. Then, turn rod so that elongated nut lies across the slot; screw rod through nut until rod is rmly against the top of the recess.
Features: Nut may be put on hanger rod before insertion, avoiding need of locating nut in insert body prior to
inserting rod.
Insert nut, when located in position, wedges against the sloping sides of insert, providing greater
support than if resting on lower edge of the insert body.
Fig. 281: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
1 4
Max Load s
240 730 1,130 1,200
Weight
0.82 0.86 0.89 0.86 0.93
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
1 /2 "
v v 27/32" 1 1 /4 " v v v A
Insert Only
1 4 3 8
v
v
Nut Only
1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
adj.* v
s Based on insert and nut only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
PH 73
Concrete Inserts
Wedge-shaped body is so held by concrete in compression thus increasing load carrying capacity. Easily removed knockout plate. Rod can be adjusted along complete length of slot. One body for six sizes of rod. Ordering: Specify gure number, name and size of nut.
v v v
Return to TOC
CONCRETE INSERTS
Fig. 285
Size Range: 1 4 " through 5 8 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Upper attachment for suspending pipe or conduit from concrete ceiling. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 18)
WW-H-171-E (Type 18) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 19). UL, FM and ULC Approved (Sizes 3/8" - 5/8").
Installation:
1. Nail insert to wooden forms. 2. Reinforcing rods may be located under the arched anges at the top of the insert. However, note that the specied load ratings and approvals are not dependent on the use of any reinforcing rods in contact with the insert. 3. After concrete is poured and wooden forms are removed, remove knockout by tapping along edge with pointed instrument. 4. Slip nut into insert and screw rod through nut until rod is rmly against the top of the insert body.
Features: Suitable for use in concrete 2" thick due to low overall height. Highly competitive. Provides for 2" of lateral adjustment. Knockout prevents seepage of concrete from underneath the insert up into the insert body. One body size. Removable nut in four sizes. Rod can be rigidly locked in position. Ordering: Specify gure number, name, nish and size of nut.
Fig. 285: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A Insert Complete With Nut
v v
1 4 3 8 1 2 5 8
Max Load s
230 400
Weight
0.46 0.49 0.49 0.48
3 3 /4 "
2 1 /2 " 1 1 /4 "
v v v
PH 74
v A
v v v
5/32"
v v 1 1 /4 " 1" v
1 4 3 8 1 2
0.41
0.07
5 8 s Based on insert and nut only. Rating is subject to the condition that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
Return to TOC
CONCRETE INSERTS
Iron Cross Design
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 18) WW-H-171-E (Type 18) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 18). Installation:
(1) Nail insert to wooden forms. (2) Locate berglass bars to rest upon existing reinforcing rods or wire the insert directly into existing reinforced rods to achieve the specied load ratings.
Features: Stainless steel body prevents corrosion. Cone shaped body. Exceptional pullout strength. Eliminates uncertainty of tying conventional inserts into bridge deck rebars. Ordering: Specify gure number, name and rod size.
v
FIBERGLASS RODS 12" LONG 316 SS RODS AVAILABLE UPON REQUEST
Fig. 286:
4
Rod Size A
v
3 4 7 8
DISC
3 1 2
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
s Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the insert.
PH 75
Concrete Inserts
v
v
v
v
v
Return to TOC
CONCRETE INSERTS
Fig. 284
Size Range: 3 8 " through 3 4 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: Recommended for suspending pipe or conduit in metal
concrete deck forms for a variety of rod sizes. May be used with a rod coupling such as the Fig. 135 or 136 to allow for extended rod lengths.
Features: L and H can be specied for a custom t if your particular deck does
not accommodate type A, B, or C.
Ordering: Specify Figure 284, design type (A, B, C) and bolt diameter.
If your specic deck will not t one of the design types and/or a different bolt size is required, specify leg height (H), opening (L) and bolt size.
Before pouring concrete, locate the Figure 284 on deck so legs rest in valleys of form. Drill hole in deck for bolt.
v W v
Fig. 284: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Type Bolt Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8
Max Load s
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 730 1,350 2,160 3,230 730 1,350 2,160 3,230
Weight
1.33
v H v v A v
9 5 8
1 3 4
1 1 2
1 2 5 8 3 4 3 8
12
1 1 2
1 2 5 8 3 4
16
1 1 2
s Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete used is of sufcient strength to hold the deck hanger.
PH 76
Return to TOC
CONCRETE ATTACHMENTS
Concrete Single Lug Plate
Fig. 47
Size Range: 1 / 2 " through 2 Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Structural attachment to concrete ceiling lug is used in
conjunction with Fig. 299 (see page PH-87.) forged steel clevis and anchors of sufcient strength to hold the desired load.
v v
v
v G U (pin dia.)
v J v v
v T
F Dia. (4 Places)
Fig. 47: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Max Load s
1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600
Weight
11.1 14.6 14.8 22.0 31.9 43.8 45.6 55.7 58.2
E
4 7 8
F
9 16
G
3 8 1 2
T
1 4
U
5 8 3 4 7 8
10
5 4 13 16
11 16 13 16 15 16
1 1 2
1 1 4
3 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2
8 2 12 6
5 3 4 5 11 16 5 5 8
3 4
1 1 1 8 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 7 8 2 1 4
1 1 2 2
1 2 5 8
1 1 8 1 3 8
1 1 1 4
3 4
2 1 2 3
3 4
s Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete and anchors used are of sufcient strength to hold the load.
PH 77
Concrete Inserts
C B J v
v v v
v v
Return to TOC
CONCRETE ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 49
Size Range: 3 8 " through 13 4 " Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Structural attachment to concrete ceiling where exibility
is desired. Concrete clevis plate is normally used in conjunction with Fig. 290, page PH-89, weldless eye nut, or Fig. 278 page PH-82 welded eye rod and anchors of sufcient strength to hold the desired load.
Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. Note: Sizes 38" through 1" are supplied with bolt and nut. Larger sizes
are supplied with pin and cotters.
G D v v v v R v S T v v v
v
v v v J v v B C
v
F (4 PLACES) v
Fig. 49: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Max Load s
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600
Weight
11.8 11.9 15.7 16.9
9 16
1 8
10
5
11 16 1 2
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4
13 16 15 16
1 1 8 1 3 8
s Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete and anchors used are of sufcient strength to hold the load.
PH 78
U
1 2
3 8
7 8
1 1 4
1 4
5 8 3 4
1 1 8 3 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 4 5 2 1 2 2 3 4
1 7 8 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2
3 8
7 8
1 1 1 8 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 7 8
2 1 2 3 4 5
3 4
1 2 5 8 3 4 1 2
1 1 1 4
Return to TOC
CONCRETE ATTACHMENTS
Concrete Rod Attachment Plate
Fig. 52
Size Range: 3 8 " through 114" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Structural attachment to concrete ceiling
where vertical adjustment is desired. Normally used with threaded rod and nut and anchors of sufcient strength to hold the desired load.
G D v v v v H v v v E
C B J v v
v v J v v
B C
v
F (4 PLACES) v
Fig. 52: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Max Load s
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500
Weight
11.6 11.6 15.1 16.1 16.7 34.9 40.9
E
2 1 4 2 1 8
G
3 8
9 16
2 7 8 3 1 8 4 1 4 4 1 2 5
1 8
10
2 1 4 3 1 8
11 16
1 2
1 1 1 4
12
3 1 2 3 5 8
13 16
3 4
s Based on the rod diameter only. Rating is subject to the conditions that the concrete and anchors used are of sufcient strength to hold the load.
PH 79
Concrete Inserts
v v
Return to TOC
HANGER RODS
Fig. 142 Coach Screw Rods Machine Threaded on Opposite End
Size Range: 3 8 " and 1 2" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and rod length.
L v v C A D
Standard Length - L
3 1 2 8 3 1 2 8
v
1 2
Max Load
390 640
2 1 2
3 4
2 1 2
Fig. 146
Size Range: 1 4 " through 112" Stocked in six, ten, and twelve foot lengths. Other even foot lengths can be furnished to order. Material: Carbon steel; rod threaded complete length. Finish: Plain or galvanized. Maximum Temperature: 650 F. Ordering: Specify rod diameter and length, gure number,
name and nish.
Rod Size A
1 1 1 4
13,800 1 1 2 Note: Other rod sizes available upon request. Class 2 t is available upon request.
PH 80
Return to TOC
HANGER RODS
Machine Threaded Rods Threaded Both Ends
Fig. 140: Right-hand Threads Fig. 253: Right and Left hand Threads
v
D
v v
Specify thread length if other than standard. Fig. 140, 253: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Fig. 140, 253: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) (cont.) Rod Size A
2 3 4
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169
2 1 2
3 3 1 4
3 3 1 2 4 5 6 7 8 9 10
3 1 2 3 3 4 4 4 1 4 4 1 2 4 3 4 5
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2
*Fig. 140 rod up to 1" rod size and 24" in length may be furnished as Fig 146 rod unless order states that all thread rod is not acceptable. Furnished with 8 UN threads.
Fig. 248: Right Hand Threads Fig. 248L: Left Hand Threads
Size Range: 38" through 212" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized. Maximum Temperature: 650 F Features: Through 112", inside diameter of eye will
accommodate a bolt diameter 1 8 " larger than rod diameter; 134" and larger, inside diameter of eye will take a bolt diameter 1 4 " larger than rod diameter.
Fig. 248, Fig. 248L: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
L (min)
4 1 4 4 1 2 5 1 2 6 1 2 7 1 4 8 1 4 10 12 14 15 1 2 17
1
A v
1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2
v D
v v
PH 81
Hanger Rods
v
D
Size Range: 38" through 5" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, rod length and nish.
750 F
38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 88,807
Return to TOC
HANGER RODS
Fig. 278: Right Hand Threads Fig. 278L: Left Hand Threads
Size Range: 38" through 212" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Features: Through 112", inside diameter of eye will
accommodate a bolt diameter 1 8 " larger than rod diameter; 134" and larger, inside diameter of eye will take a bolt diameter 1 4 " larger than rod diameter. Fig. 278, Fig. 278L: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4
Maximum Temperature: 750 F Ordering: Specify rod diameter, gure number, name, rod
length and nish. Specify thread length if other than standard.
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169
WELDED
A v v D v v
7 8
Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: Fig. 248X: 650 F, Fig. 278X: 750 F Ordering: Specify the size, length of each eye rod, gure number and nish. Example:
7 8
(L1) (L2)
L1 v
A L1 v WELDED v A L2 v v v v
PH 82
v
L v v v
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2
Fig. 248X, 278X: Dimensions (in) Loads (lbs) Max Load Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169
Fig. 278 welded eye rod 1 ft. 2 1 2 in. long, center to end. Fig. 278 welded eye rod 1 ft. 2 1 2 in. long center to end.
L2 v
7 8
1
Fig. 248X
1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2
Fig. 278X
2 1 4 2 1 2
Return to TOC
HANGER RODS
Rod with Eye End
Fig. 148
Size Range: 23 4 " through 5" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: A large diameter rod with eye end for load ratings thru 184,000 pounds. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name, nish and L dimension. Indicate if desired
thread length is other than standard.
E
v
Fig. 148: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4 4 1 4 4 1 2 4 3 4 5
750 F
38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 88,807 101,337 114,807 128,982 144,096
B
9 5 8 11 12 1 4 12 1 2 13 7 8 15 1 8 16 1 4 16
E
3 3 4
H
3 1 8 3 3 8 3 5 8
L (Min)
19 20 21 24 25 26 30 31 32
R
3 5 8 4 4 1 4 4 1 2 4 7 8 5 1 8 5 1 2 5 3 4 6 6 3 8
6 1 1 2 7 7 1 2 8 1 2 9 1 2 8 1 2 2 1 2 9 1 2 10
12 4 4 3 4 15 5 5 1 4 18 5 3 4 6 1 4
3 7 8 4 1 8 4 3 8 4 5 8 4 7 8 5 1 8 5 3 8
17 17 7 8
*Weight calculated with minimum L for standard thread Furnished with 8 UN series threads
PH 83
Hanger Rods
v v
5 v v H
v
v R v v
L (MIN)
v
Return to TOC
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 135: Straight With Sight-Hole Fig. 135E: Straight Less Sight-Hole Fig. 135R: Reducing
Size Range: 14" through 1" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Fig. 135:Plain; Fig.135E and Fig.135R Galvanized Service: For connecting rods to accommodate up to 1"
diameter and support up to 5,900 pounds.
Rod Coupling
Fig 135, 135E, 135R: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A Max Load Weight D L
5 8 3 4 15 16
1 3 4 1 1 2 17 8 2 1 4 22 8 3
1 1 8 1 5 16 1 1 2
3 8 5 8 11 16 13 16
7 8
Sight Hole
3 8 1 2 5 8
1 3 4 2 1 4
3 4
v D v v
x 1 4 x x x
3 8
5 8 11 16 13 16
1 3 4 2 1 8 2 1 4 2 1 2
x 1 2
5 8 3 4
1 1 1 4
Rod Coupling
Fig. 136, 136R: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A Max Load Weight L D
13 8 15 8 21 8 21 2 25 8 23 1 6 23 4
5 8 11 16 15 16
11 8 11 4 15 8 11 3 1 6
7 8
PH 84
v v
x 1 4 x 3 8
230 730
0.10 0.21
1 5 8 2 1 8
1 5 8 2 1 8
Return to TOC
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Turnbuckle Adjuster
A v v E v B
v
E
1 1 4 1 7 8 1 13 16 2 5 16
Fig. 114
Size Range: 1/4" through 3/4" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Installation: Normally used with split pipe ring, Fig. 108, see page PH-22 Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 15)
WW-H-171-E (Type 15) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 15).
Maximum Temperature: 450 F Features: An economical and simple means of obtaining vertical adjustment Permits adjustment after pipe is in place. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number and name.
v
Weight
0.09 0.28 730 860 0.31 0.72 0.70
H v
H
7 32 13 32 1 2 9 16
Fig. 114: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
1 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4
Max Load
230
B
2 1 2 3 13 16 4 7 8 4 15 16
Fig. 110R
Size Range: 1/4" through 7/8" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain Service: For attaching hanger rod to various types of building attachments Maximum Temperature: 450 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 16)
WW-H-171-E (Type 16) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 16). UL and FM Approved (Sizes 3/8" - 7/8").
Installation: Normally used with the split pipe ring Fig. 108, see page PH-22. Ordering: Specify rod tapping size, gure number and name.
"B" MAX
Rod Size A
1 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Max Load
650 800 1,000 1,400 2,200 2,300
E
1 1 8 1 11 32 1 17 32 1 13 16 2 5 32 2 11 32
PH 85
Return to TOC
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 157
Size Range: 3/8" through 7/8" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: 450 F Service: For attaching hanger rod to various types of building attachments. Approvals: UL and FM Approved. Installation: May be used to form an integral part of malleable iron beam clamps
Fig. 218, see page PH-55.
Extension piece
v E
v K v
Fig. 157: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Max Load
730 1,350 1,550 2,100 2,350
v
v
PH 86
v
v
v
Weight
0.20 0.40 0.44 0.65 0.78
B
1 1 4 1 3 8 1 1 2 1 3 4 1 7 8
C
2 1 16 2 5 16 2 7 16 2 7 8 2
Rod Take-Out E
1 1 4 1 3 8 1 7 16 1 11 16 1 3 4
G
1 2
K
9 16
5 8
1 2
11 16 3 4 7 8
3 4
9 16
Return to TOC
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Forged Steel Clevis
Fig. 299
Size Range: 3/8" through 4" Material: Forged steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For use on high temperature piping installations. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 14)
WW-H-171-E (Type 14) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 14).
Features: Available with pin and cotter pins, if required. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. If pin and cotter pins are
required, specify with pin. If other than standard combination of clevis number and rod size is required, specify clevis number, special rod tapping size, pin size, grip.
A v v B P D v v v W v v v
v N v v T v v GRIP T v v
Fig. 299: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169 38,687 47,066 56,307 66,331 77,139 88,807
With Pin
1.0 0.9 0.9 3.0 3.4 5.1 5.5 8.5 12.9 23.3 35.1 36.0 50.0 51.5 116.0 118.0 120.0 122.0
Pin Dia. P
1 2 5 8 3 4
Grip
1 2 5 8
Clevis No.
1 7 16
5 8
5 16
1 1 16
2 5 3 6 7 8 9 3 1 2 4 5 6 7
7 8
7 8
1 1 1 8 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 7 8 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4 4 1 2
3 8
1 1 4 1 1 2
3 4 7 8
2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4
1 5 16 1 5 8 1 3 4 2 1 4 2 3 4 3
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
1 2
1 3 4 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2
5 8 3 4
2 1 2
6 7
7 8
10
1 1 2
PH 87
Rod Attachments
Return to TOC
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Fig. 230
Size Range: 3/8" through 212" Material: Forged steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Provides adjustment up to 12" for heavy loads. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 13)
WW-H-171-E (Type 13) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 13).
Turnbuckle
Fig. 230: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4
650F
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800
750F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 31,169
B=12" Opening
1.20 1.58 2.35 4.05 4.02
Fig. 233
Size Range: 11 4 " through 5" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Services: Provides adjustments up to 24" with loads
up thru 184,000 pounds.
A v F v
v B = Opening
C L
Sight Holes
v F v
PH 88
v
v
12 B B" ROD TAKE OUT
7 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2
Tapped right hand and left hand thread Larger rod sizes or openings available upon request
Turnbuckle
Fig. 233: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size* A
1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4 4 1 4 4 1 2 4 3 4 5
4 7 16
Furnished with 8 UN series threads. *Tapped right hand and left hand thread.
Return to TOC
ROD ATTACHMENTS
Weldless Eye Nut
Features: Supports loads equal to the full limitation of the hanger rod. Provides exible connection when used with straight thread rod. Ordering: Specify rod size, gure number, name and nish. If other than
standard combination of eye nut number and rod size, specify eye nut number and special rod tapping size.
v G C v v v D E B v v v v
v v v
Fig. 290, 290L: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Size A
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
750 F
572 1,057 1,692 2,530 3,508 4,620 7,440 10,807 14,566 19,265 25,295 0.63 0.63 0.62 0.60 1.70 1.70 3.60 3.50 16.40 15.90 15.40 14.90 4 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 1 11 16 1 13 16
3 4
1 1 2
1 3 16
1 2
1 3 8
11 16
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4
2 5 8 3 3 8
1 15 16 2 3 8
1 1 1 4
2 3
6 1 4
2 1 4
PH 89
Rod Attachments
Return to TOC
Ordering: Specify pin diameter, gure number, name, nish and if cotter
pins are required.
W E
v
H
PH 90
v
1 1 1 8 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 7 8 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4
Fig. 291: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Load Weight 750 F
572 1,057 1,691 2,529 3,508 4,620 5,802 7,439 10,805 14,564 19,262 25,291 31,163 38,680 47,058 56,298 66,320 77,125 0.12 0.18 0.29 0.47 0.67 1.00 1.70 2.10 3.30 4.80 7.20 9.30 12.50 16.60 20.00 23.90 25.10 34.80 7 1 8 7 5 8 7 7 8 8 1 4 8 1 2 8 3 4 9 1 2 9 3 4 5 7 8 6 3 8 6 5 8 6 3 4 7 7 1 4 8 8 1 4
1 2 3 4 1 2 1 2 5 8 3 8
L
2 7 8 3 1 8 3 5 8 4 4 3 4 4 7 8 5 3 8 6
W
2 1 8 2 3 8 2 7 8
730 1,350 2,160 3,230 4,480 5,900 7,410 9,500 13,800 18,600 24,600 32,300 39,800 49,400 60,100 71,900 84,700 98,500
5 32
x 1 1 4
3 8
3 16 7 32
x 1 1 2
3 1 4 4 4 1 4 4 3 8 5
3 8
3 16
x 2
1 2
9 32
1 4
x 2
3 8 x
3 8 x
x 5
x 6
Return to TOC
Machine Bolts
Size Range: American Standard hexagon head bolts with American
Standard hexagon nuts are stocked in sizes 38" through 118" UNC thread series. Other sizes are available upon request. Lengths of bolts are measured from under head to extreme point.
Hexagon Nuts
Size Range: American Standard hexagon nuts sizes 1 4 thru 11 2 ". Hex Nuts: Dimensions (in) Bolt /Rod Size
1 4 3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
Width
7 16 9 16 3 4 15 16
Thickness
15 64 11 32 29 64 9 16 43 64 25 32 57 64
Width
2 3 4 3 1 8 3 1 2 3 7 8 4 1 4 4 5 8 5 5 3 8 5 3 4
Thickness
1 25 32 2 1 32 2 19 64 2 35 64 2 13 16 3 1 16 3 5 16 3 9 16 3 13 16
1 1 8 1 5 16 1 1 2 1 7 8 2 1 16 2 1 4
1 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 1 2
1 3 32 1 13 64 1 5 16
PH 91
Return to TOC
U-BOLTS
Fig. 137: Standard U-bolt Fig. 137S*: Special U-bolt (non-standard)
Size Range: 1 2 " through 36" Material: Carbon steel U-bolt and four nished hex nuts Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for support, or guide of heavy loads; often employed in power,
process plant and marine service.
U-Bolts
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 24) WW-H-171-E (Type 24) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 24). Ordering Fig. 137: Specify rod size x pipe size (e.g., 5 8 x 6), gure number, name. U-bolt will be furnished with longer tangents D or with longer threads E if so required and ordered. If hex nuts are not required, specify without hex nuts. Ordering Fig. 137S: Specify gure number, name, material specication, dimensions A, B, C, D, and E, and with hex nuts or without hex nuts.
Fig. 137: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) s Pipe Size
1 2 3 4 1 4
Rod Size A
750 F
454
B
15 16
C
1 3 16 1 3 8 1 5 8 2 1 16 2 3 8 2 13 16 3 7 16 4 1 16 4 9 16 5 1 16 6 1 8 7 3 8 9 3 8 11 5 8 13 3 4 15 17 19 1 8 21 1 8 25 1 8 29 1 8 31 1 8 37 1 8
F
2 5 16
1 1 8 1 3 8 1 11 16 2 2 7 16 2 15 16 3 9 16 4 1 16 4 9 16 5 5 8 6 3 4 8 3 4 10 7 8 12 7 8 14 1 8 16 1 8 18 1 8 20 1 8 24 1 8 28 1 8 30 1 8 36 1 8
2 3 4 2 7 8 3 3 1 4 3 3 4 4 4 1 4 4 1 2 5 6 1 8 7 1 8 8 3 8 9 5 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 28 30 36 1 11,800 9,240
7 8 5 8 3 4 1 2 3 8
2 1 8
2 7 32 2 3 32 2 1 32
C B v v v v A v v v v
1,460
1,144
365
2 1 2
2 1 16 2 5 16
F
2,700
2,114
675
0.84 0.90 1.0 2.0 2.3 4.9 7.7 8.3 9.2 13.5 14.6 16.9 18.0 19.1 23.2
6,460 9,960
5,060 7,016
1,615 2,490
3 3 1 4
10 1 4 4 1 4 11 1 4 12 5 8 13 5 8 15 5 8 17 5 8 18 5 8 21 5 8 4 3 4
3 5 8
s loads, weights and dimensions shown do not apply for Fig. 137S Max load rating for carbon steel is 2 x max load rating for rod size "A" Max load rating for stainless steel is .85 x 2 x max load rating for rod size "A" *When the combination of a normal load and a side load occurs, a straight line interaction formula may be used to determine if the Fig. 137 is still within the allowable stress range: Pn/Pna + Ps/Psa 1 Where: Pn = actual applied normal load; Pna = allowable normal load for the Fig. 137; Ps = actual applied side load; Psa = allowable side load for the Fig. 137 Nuts must be snug tight in installation to achieve side loads shown.
PH 92
4,320
3,382
1,080
3 3 4 2 13 16
C L
2 7 32
2 1 4
E D
Return to TOC
U-BOLTS
U-Bolts
Ordering: Specify rod size x pipe size (e.g., 3 8 x 2), gure number and name.
If hex nuts are not required, specify without hex nuts. Fig. 137C: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
1 2 3 4 1 4
Rod Size A
Max Load
580
Weight
0.11 0.12 0.12 0.28 0.30 0.33 0.73 0.78 0.84 0.90 1.00 2.00 2.30
B
15 16
C
1 3 16 1 3 8 1 5 8 2 1 16 2 3 8 2 13 16 3 7 16 4 1 16 4 9 16 5 1 16 6 1 8 7 3 8 9 3 8
D
2 3 4 2 7 8 3 3 1 4 3 3 4 4 4 1 4 4 1 2 5 6 1 8 7 1 8
F
C B
v
2 7 32 3 3 4 2 13 16
PLASTIC COATING
5 8
4,320
Fig. 120
Size Range: 1 2 " through 10" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Recommended for support, or guide of relatively light loads. Normally used with two hex nuts. Maximum Temperature: 650 F. Ordering: Specify rod size x pipe size, gure number and name. Hex nuts must be ordered separately.
Fig. 120: Loads (lbs) Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in)
Pipe Size
1 2 3 4
Max Load
Rod Size A
B
15 16
C 1 3 16 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 15 16 2 1 4 2 11 16 3 5 16 3 15 16 4 7 16 4 15 16 6 7 1 4 9 1 4 11 1 2
D 1 15 16 2 1 16 2 3 16 2 3 8 2 7 16 2 11 16 3 1 16 3 5 8 3 7 8 4 9 16 5 1 16 6 1 16 7 1 4 3 3 8
E
C B v v A v v
1 1 8
1 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10
580
1 3 8 1 11 16 2 2 7 16 2 15 16 3 9 16
1 3 4
E D
1,460
3 8
4 1 16 4 9 16 5 5 8 6 3 4 8 3 4 10 7 8
2
C L
2,700 4,320
1 2 5 8
2 1 4 2 1 2
PH 93
1 2
2,700
2 1 4
C L
2 5 16
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8
3 8
1,460
1 1 8 1 3 8 1 11 16 2 2 7 16 2 15 16 3 9 16 4 1 16 4 9 16 5 5 8 6 3 4 8 3 4
2 1 8
2 5 16 2 7 32 2 3 32 2 1 32 2 1 16
A v v v F E D
2 1 2
Return to TOC
STRAPS
Fig. 262
Size Range: 1 2 " through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: 650 F Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 26)
WW-H-171-E (Type 26) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 26).
Strap Short
Pipe Size
v B v
1 2 3 4
v v
L
4
C
23 4 31 8 31 2 33 4 41 8 51 8 61 1 6 69 1 6 71 8
D
1 2 1116 1116
E
11 8 17 16 15 8 21 8 21 2 23 4 35 8 4 45 8 5
1 11 4
v v D v E v
F v v C L
Two #18 x 2 steel wood screws or two 3 8 " bolts to steel Two #18 x 3 steel wood screws or two 3 8 " bolts to steel
43 8 43 4 5 53 8 63 8 61 3 1 6 75 1 6 71 3 1 6 83 8 11 2 11 4
1116 13 8 11 4 17 8 23 1 6 23 8
1 8
59 1 6 13 4
1 4
Fig. 126
Size Range: 3 8 " through 4" Material: Malleable iron Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For support of standard conduit, cable and steel pipe on walls or sides of beams.
Not recommended for use horizontally on ceilings, bottoms of beams and similar installations since the factor of safety is greatly reduced when so used.
One-Hole Clamp
Maximum Temperature: 450 F Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish. Specify nominal size of
conduit or pipe or outside diameter of lead cable with which the clamp is to be used. Fig. 126: Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 8
Weight
0.03 0.03 0.05 0.09 0.12 0.16 0.25 0.49 0.82 1.30
Dia. of Hole - A
1 4
Size Screw/Bolt
No. 10
C L
1 2 3 4
516
1 11 4 11 2 2
v
1 4
3 8 716 3 8
PH 94
21 2 3 4
1116 3 4
5 8
Return to TOC
STRAPS
Pipe Strap
Fig. 243
Size Range: 1 2 " through 6" pipe Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: Restraint of pipe in specied direction while permitting
movement in non-restrained direction.
Maximum Temperature: 650 F Ordering: Specify Fig. number, name, and pipe size.
Larger sizes available upon request.
L
3 3 1 2 4 4 1 2 5 5 1 2 6 6 1 2 7 1 2 9 3 4
T
1 4
W
2
Rated Load Pn
600
v Pn 116 v C L
v
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 6
3 8
1,500 2,500
FIELD WELD T v v W
1 2
4 6
2,800 3,000
Fig. 244
Size Range: 1 2 " through 6" pipe Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain Service: Restraint of pipe in specied direction while permitting
movement in non-restrained direction.
Maximum Temperature: 650 F Ordering: Specify Fig. number, name, and pipe size.
Larger sizes available upon request. Fig. 244: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rated Load Pipe Size Ps
1 2 3 4
L Pn
1 250 1,500 1 3 16 1 7 16 1 3 4 500 2,000 2 2 1 2 3 650 700 2,300 3 9 16 4 9 16 6 3 4
1 4
2
v Pn
1 16
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 6
3 8
3
Ps v C L
FIELD WELD T v v W
1 2
PH 95
Straps
v
v v v v
Pipe Strap
Return to TOC
PIPE SUPPORTS
Fig. 62, Type A, B and C Pipe Stanchion
C L v v Field Weld D
1 4 "
Top Stanchion
Field Weld D
Top Stanchion
Vent Hole
1 4 "
Vent Hole
1 4 "
Vent Hole
v v
Bottom Stanchion
2 Std. 3 Std. 5 Std. 6 Std.
3 8 3 8 3 8
To Order Specify:
Figure Number, Type, Pipe Size, Top Stanchion Size, Material Specication and "D" Dimension.
PH 96
Base Plate
3 8
x 6 x 6
x 10 x 10 x 10 x 10 x 10 x 10
Return to TOC
PIPE SUPPORTS
Pipe Stanchion
C L
v
v v
1 4 "
D
1 4 "
14"
Vent Hole
Stanchion
To Order Specify:
Figure Number, Type, Pipe Size, Stanchion Size, Material Specication and "D" Dimension.
PH 97
Pipe Supports
Base Plate
Base Plate
3 8
x 6 x 6
3 8
x 8 x 8
3 8 3 8 1 2 1 2 1 2
x 10 x 10 x 14 x 14 x 18 x 18 20 22 24 30 x x x x 20 22 24 30
x x 1 2 x 1 2 x
Return to TOC
PIPE SUPPORTS
Fig. 192 Adjustable Pipe Saddle Support
Size Range: 2" through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support for stationary pipe where vertical adjustment is required. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 38) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 38). Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name and nish.
Pipe Size
v
Rod Size A
E
9 7 16
Weight
1.0
v
120
2 2 1 2
v
G
3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12
5 8
9 11 16 10 10 1 4 10 1 2 11 11 1 1 1 6 12 1 1 1 6 13 7 8 14 7 8
1 4
x 1
v E
7 8
1 4
x 1 1 4 x 1 1 2 x 2
8"
1 1 1 4
3 8
1 2
Fig. 191
Size Range: 2" through 12" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support where vertical adjustment is required, plus the additional stability
provided by U-bolt attachment to stationary pipe.
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 37) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 37). Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number, name and nish.
v E
8" A
PH 98
Pipe Size
G
Rod Size A
C
2 11 16
E
9 7 16 9 11 16 10 10 1 4 10 1 2 11 11 1 1 1 6 12 1 1 1 6 13 7 8 14 7 8
1 4 1 4
Weight
1.2
2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12
7 8 5 8
3 5 16 3 15 16 4 7 16 5 1 4 6 1 8 7 1 4 9 3 8 11 1 2 13 1 2
x 1
x 1 1 4 x 1 1 2 x 2
1 1 1 4
3 8
1 2
Return to TOC
PIPE SUPPORTS
Pipe Saddle Support
Fig. 258
Size Range: 4" through 36" Material: Cast iron saddle through 12", 14" through 36" carbon steel saddle.
4" through 12" steel saddle available on special request.
Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support for stationary pipe. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 36)
WW-H-171-E (Type 36 & 37) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 36).
Installation: Slip saddle base into riser pipe. Ordering: Specify size to be supported, gure number, name,
nish and material. Fig. 258 Cast
C L
v
Pipe Size
4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 30 32 36
4 13 16 5 7 16 6 15 16 8 7 16 9 15 16 10 1 2 11 1 2 13 1 2 14 1 2 15 1 2 17 1 2 18 1 2 20 5 8 21 5 8 23 5 8
3 5 8
8 3 4
PH 99
Pipe Supports
v
v
B
4 3 16
Width C
Return to TOC
PIPE SUPPORTS
Fig. 264
Size Range: 2 1 2 " through 36" Material: Cast iron saddle, locknut nipple and special cast iron reducer, assembled. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support where vertical adjustment of stationary pipe is required. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 38)
WW-H-171-E (Type 39) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 38).
Installation: Adjustment is obtained by turning the locknut nipple. The lower end of the nipple is staked, upsetting the threads to prevent separation of nipple and coupling during adjustment. Features: Vertical adjustment of approximately 41 2 " Saddle supports a broad range of pipe sizes Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name and nish.
C L
v
Fig. 264: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 32
Weight Complete
9.0 9.2 9.4 15.0 16.7 17.7 20.2 25.2 29.0 40.2 53.2 70.8 104.8 137.0 170.0 181.0
Saddle Only
4.8 5.0 5.2 7.6 8.3 10.3 12.8 17.8 21.6 38.0 42.0 51.0 85.0 110.0 150.0 161.1
36 249.0 229.0 *The special cast iron reducer may be furnished with a hexed shaped smaller end.
PH 100
v
v
v
v
v
v 3"
B
3 1 2
E Min
8 8 1 4 8 1 2 9 1 4 10
Max
13 13 1 4 13 1 2 14 14 3 4 15 1 4 16 1 2 18 1 4 19 3 4 20 3 4 22 1 4 24 25 1 2 28 1 4 31 1 2 32 3 4 34 3 4
Width C
2 1 2
3 3 4 4 4 1 4 4 7 8 5 1 2 6 7 8 8 1 2 9 15 16 10 1 5 1 6 12 3 8 13 7 8 15 3 8 17 1 5 1 6 21 5 1 6 22 1 2 24 1 2
1 1 2
2 1 2
10 1 2 11 3 4 13 1 2 15
3 5 8
3 3 1 2
16 1 4 17 3 4 19 1 2 21 23 3 4 27 28 1 4 30 1 4
4 5 8
6 3 4
8 3 4
Return to TOC
PIPE SUPPORTS
Adjustble Pipe Saddle Support
Fig. 265
Size Range: 4 " through 36" Material: Cast iron saddle, steel yoke and nuts, steel locknut nipple and special cast iron reducer.
(14" through 36" carbon steel saddle with steel yoke. 4" through 12" Steel saddle available upon special request)
Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support where vertical adjustment of stationary pipe is required. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 38)
WW-H-171-E (Type 39) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 38).
Installation: Adjustment is obtained by turning the locknut nipple. The lower end of the nipple is staked, upsetting the threads to prevent separation of nipple and coupling during adjustment. Features: Vertical adjustment of approximately 41 2 " Saddle supports a broad range of pipe sizes Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name and nish.
C v v
C L v
Fig. 264: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 32
Weight Complete
22.0 23.1 23.9 32.5 36.9 42.4 39.2 42.2 60.0 63.0 72.0 89.0 93.0
10.8 12.1 12.7 21.3 25.7 31.2 28.0 31.0 40.0 43.0 52.0 69.0 73.0 6 4
4 3 16 4 13 16 5 7 16 6 15 16 8 7 16 9 15 16 10 1 2 11 1 2 13 1 2 14 1 2 17 1 2 20 5 8 21 5 8 23 5 8 4 3 1 2 3
9 1 2 10 1 8 10 3 4 12 1 4 13 3 4 14 5 8 15 1 3 1 6 16 1 3 1 6 19 1 8 20 1 8 23 5 1 6 26 7 1 6 27 7 1 6 29 7 1 6
14 14 5 8 15 1 4 16 3 4 18 1 4 19 1 8 20 5 1 6 21 5 1 6 23 5 8 24 5 8 27 1 3 1 6 30 1 5 1 6 31 1 5 1 6 33 1 5 1 6 6 3 5 8
36 101.0 81.0 *The special cast iron reducer may be furnished with a hexed shaped smaller end.
PH 101
Pipe Supports
Saddle Only
v v v
v 3"
E Min Max
Width C
Return to TOC
PIPE SUPPORTS
Fig. 259
Size Range: 4" through 36" pipe Material: Cast iron stanchion saddle with steel yoke and nuts. 14" through 36" carbon
steel saddle with steel yoke. 4" through 12" steel saddle available on special request.
Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Stanchion type support where vertical adjustment is required,
plus the additional stability provided by U-bolt attachment to pipe.
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 37) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 37). Installation: Same as pipe saddle support Fig. 258, except that yoke is
attached to saddle after pipe is in place.
Features: U-bolt yoke provides stability. Ordering: Specify pipe size to be supported, gure number, name, material and nish.
Fig. 259 Cast Iron
C L v
C L v
PH 102
v v
v 3"
Weight
10.8 12.1 12.7 21.3 25.7 31.2 28.0 31.0 40.0 43.0 46.0 52.0 55.0 69.0 73.0 81.0
B
4 3 16 4 13 16 5 7 16 6 15 16 8 7 16 9 15 16 10 1 2 11 1 2 13 1 2 14 1 2 15 1 2 17 1 2 18 1 2 20 5 8 21 5 8 23 5 8
Width C
3 5 8
Return to TOC
TRAPEZE
Universal Trapeze Assembly
Fig. 46
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: Trapeze assembly is to be suspended by two rods with
Fig. 60 washer plates and is designed for top loading exclusively.
Ordering: Specify size number, gure number, name, nish, C to C dimension and hole size H. If holes J or hole D are required, also specify hole size and dimensions K and M or B. Note: Larger C to C dimensions are available upon request.
L N C TO C K M K v v v v N v v v v
H HOLE
(2 PLACES)
J HOLE D HOLE
(2 PLACES)
Fig. 46: Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Size Size Weight Tubing
1 2 3 4 5 6
14x2x2 14x3x2 316x4x3 14x4x4 14x6x4 14x8x4
v G v v
v
v
28
30
36
42
48
54
60
23 1 4 25 1 4 27 1 4 29 1 4 31 1 4 33 1 4 35 1 4 41 1 4 47 1 4 53 1 4 59 1 4 65 1 4 30 3 4 32 3 4 34 3 4 36 3 4 42 3 4 48 3 4 54 3 4 60 3 4 66 3 4 32 34 36 38 44 50 56 62 68
Fig. 46: Maximum Load (lbs); Based on C to C Dimensions at Max Temperature of 250 F Size 12
1 2 3 4 5 6 2,600 6,700
14
2,300 5,700
16
1,900 5,000
18
1,700 4,500 5,800 10,200
20
1,500 4,000 5,200 9,100
22
1,400 3,600 4,800 8,300
24
1,300 3,300 4,400 7,500 12,000 20,000
26
1,200 3,100 3,900 7,000 11,100 18,400
28
1,100 2,800 3,600 6,500 10,300 17,100
30
1,000 2,700 3,500 6,100 9,600 16,000
36
8,80 2,200 2,900 5,100 8,000 13,300
42
2,500 4,300 6,800 11,400
48
2,200 3,800 6,000 10,000
54
1,900 3,300 5,300 8,800
60
1,700 3,000 4,800 8,000
PH 103
Trapeze
Return to TOC
TRAPEZE
Fig. 45
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Ordering: Fig. 45 channel assembly; channel size, rod size,
name, nish and C to C. Note: that L = (C to C) + 2M + W
Channel Assembly
Note: Can also be used with a U-bolt Fig. 137 & Fig. 60
washer plates to secure pipe to the center of channel assembly
L CC v v
M W v v
H DIA. W v v
12
5 8 11 16
58
3 4 13 16
34
7 8 15 16
78
1
1 1 4 1 3 8 4
1 2 3 8
114
1 1 2 1 5 8 5
1 2 3 8
112
1 3 4 1 7 8 5
3 4 3 8
1 1 1 16 4
1 2 3 8
3
1 4 3 8
3
1 4 3 8
3
3 8
4
3 8
Fig. 45: Weights (lbs) Loads (lbs) C to C = Span (in) Wt./Ft. Size 2Cs
3 4 5 6 8 10 12 15 8.2 10.8 13.4 21.0 23.0 30.6 41.4 67.8
12
14
16
18
20
22
24
PH 104
v T v
134
2 2 1 4 5
3 4 3 8
2
2 1 4 2 1 2 5
3 4 3 8
214
2 1 2 2 3 4 6
3 4 3 8
212
2 3 4 3 6
3 4 3 8
234
3 3 1 4 6
3 4 3 8
3
3 1 4 3 1 2 6
3 4 1 2
314
3 1 2 3 3 4 6
3 4 1 2
312
3 3 4 4 7
3 4 1 2
26
28
30
36
42
48
54
60
111,000 95,300
Return to TOC
TRAPEZE
Equal Leg Angle for Trapeze Assembly
Fig. 50
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Ordering: If two holes H are required:
Specify Fig. 50 angle (nominal size, C to C, H, total weight and load)
L N C TO C K M
v
v H HOLE
(2 PLACES)
v K
1 1 2 2 x 2 x 2 1 2 3 x 3 x
1 4
7 8
1 1 4
1 2 5 8
1 4 3 8
1 1 8 1 3 8 1 3 4 2 1 2
1 1 2
3 4
3 8
1 1 3 4 2 1 1 4 2
3 8 1 2
6,600 12,000
4 x 1 2
PH 105
Trapeze
Size
Weight Per/Ft
D HOLE
J HOLE
(2 PLACES)
Fig. 50: Load (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max Rod Size H C to C = Span in Inches 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 28 30
Return to TOC
PIPE SHIELD
Fig. 167
Size Range: 1 2 " through 24" pipe with 1 2 ,3 4 :, 1, 11 2 , and 2 thick insulation Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Service: Recommended for outside of foam or ber glass insulation for distribution
of loads to preclude crushing of insulation without breaking the vapor barrier.
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 40) WW-H-171-E (Type 41) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 40). How to size: Refer to shield size selection table below. Ordering: Specify size, gure number and name. Data applicable to shields for
thicker insulation or larger pipe sizes is available upon request. Fig. 167: Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
1 2 3 4
Shield Size Selection for Nominal Pipe Size Insulation Thickness (in)
1/2 3/4
Size of Fig. 65 or Fig. 260 Clevis Use With Shield Outside Insulation Insulation Thickness (in)
1/2 3/4
Shield Size
X1A 1A 2A 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 10A 9B 10B 11B 12B 13C 14C 15C 16C 17C 18C 19C 20C 21C 22C 23C 24C 25C 26C 27C 28C
Weight
0.5 0.7 0.8 1.0 1.1 1.3 1.4 1.6 1.9 2.7 3.1 4.0 4.6 5.1 5.6 10.2 11.1 12.3 12.7 13.6 14.5 21.2 22.4 23.6 24.8 25.9 27.1 28.3 31.0 31.8 33.0
Stock Size
Insulation OD
1.90 2.38 2.88 3.50 4.00 4.50 5.00 5.56 6.64 7.64 8.64 7.64 8.64 9.64 10.76 11.76 12.76 14.00 15.00 16.00 17.00 18.00 19.00 20.00 21.00 22.00 23.00 24.00 26.00 27.00 28.00
1
3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9B 10B 12B 14C 16C 17C 19C 21C 23C 26C
11/2
4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 10B 11B 13C 15C 17C 18C 20C 22C 24C 27C
2
6A 7A 7A 8A 8A 9A 10A 11B 12B 14C 16C 18C 19C 21C 23C 25C 28C
1
3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 16 18 20 -
11/2
3 1 2 4 5
2
5
1A 1A 2A 3A 4A 5A 6A
2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
18 Ga. 12
2A 3A 4A 5A
2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4
6 8 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 10 12 16 18 20 24 -
16 Ga.
16 Ga.
18
14 Ga.
Shield Size Selection for Copper Tubing Insulation Thickness (in) Tube Size 1/2 3/4 1 11/2
3 8 1 2, 5 8, 3 4
24
2
5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 10A 11B 12B 14C
X1A 1A 2A 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 11B
1A 2A 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 11B
2A 3A 4A 5A 6A 7A 8A 9A 10A 12B
1, 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8
12 Ga.
INSULATION O.D.
v
Note: As actual foam or ber glass insulation thicknesses vary, verify that the radius of the selected shield is suitable for the required application. Shields are designed for a maximum span of ten feet on four P.S.I. compressive strength insulation. For compressive strengths greater than four P.S.I., spans may be increased proportionately up to maximum allowable for steel pipe. Refer to MSS-SP-69 for specic guidelines on compressive strength and maximum span.
C L
INSULATION THICKNESS
PH 106
Return to TOC
PIPE SHIELD
Rib-Lok Shield
Fig. 168
Size Range: 12" through 8" pipe or copper tube with up to 2" insulation Material: Carbon steel Finish: Galvanized Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 40)
WW-H-171-E (Type 41) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 40).
Service: To be used with Fig. 65 or Fig. 260 clevis. Designed to prevent damage to insulation by hanger. Ribs keep shield centered in hanger. How to size: Refer to shield size selection table below. Ordering: Specify size, gure number and name. Note: Data applicable to shields for thicker insulation or larger pipe size is
available upon request.
Pipe Size
Shield Size Selection for Nominal Pipe Size Insulation Thickness (in)
1/2 3/4
Sizes of Fig. 65 or Fig. 260 Clevis for Use With Shields Outside of Insulation Insulation Thickness (in)
1/2 3/4
Stock Sizes
Weight
0.44 0.52 0.63
1
2 3 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12
11/2
4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 13
2
6 7
1
3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10
11/2
3 1 2 4 5
2
5
1 2 3 4
1 2
2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 2 3 4 5
18 ga. X 8
3 4 5 6
2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4
8 9 10
8 9 10 11 12 14
6 8 8 10 12 10 12
11 12 13 14
18 ga. X 12
1
2 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 12
11/2
3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 13
2
6 7
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 11
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 11
INSULATION O.D.
v
1 1 4
INSULATION THICKNESS
1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3
8 9 10 11 12 14
C L
2"
3 1 2 4 5 6 8
PH 107
Return to TOC
PROTECTION SADDLES
Fig. 160: 1" Fig. 161: 112" Fig. 162: 2" 12" Fig. 164: 3" Fig. 165: 4" Fig. 163: 2 12" (Alloy) Fig. 165A: 4" (Alloy) Fig. 166A: 5
Size Range: 3 4 " through 36" Material: Figs. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, and 165 are curved carbon steel plate. Figs. 165A and 166A are alloy steel manufactured from ASTM A-387 Grade 22
Chrome Molybdenum steel plate.
Figs. 165A and 166A have a welded-in center plate in all sizes. All other saddles have a welded-in center plate for pipe sizes 12" and larger. All saddles are 12" long with side edges turned up. Finish: Plain Service: Designed for use on insulated high temperature systems where heat losses
are to be kept to a minimum and to protect insulation against damage.
Maximum Temperature: 650 F carbon steel, 950 F alloy steel. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 39A & 39B)
WW-H-171-E (Type 40A & 40B) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 39A & 39B).
Features: Permits nished, weather tight covering at all points of pipe support. Ordering: Specify pipe size, gure number and name. Data for 42" size
available on request.
C L C L v v C C E v D v v
PH 108
Return to TOC
PROTECTION SADDLES
Pipe Covering Protection Saddle (cont.)
Fig. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, 165, 165A, 166A: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Size of Pipe Roll Figs. 271, 274, 277
2-3 1 2
Center Line of Pipe to Center Line of Roll Center Line of Pipe to Outside of Saddle C
1 5 8 2 3 16 2 11 16 1 13 16 2-3 1 2 2 5 16 2 7 8 1 15 16 2-3 1 2 4-6 2-3 1 2 4-6 2-3 1 2 2 9 16 3 3 3 4 2 1 8 2 5 8 3 5 16 3 7 8 2 3 8 2 7 8 3 9 16 4-6 2-3 1 2 4 1 16 4 9 16 2 11 16 3 5 16 4-6 3 7 8 4 1 4 4 7 8 2-3 1 2 4-6 8-10 4-6 2 15 16 3 5 8 4 1 8 4 11 16 5 1 16 3 5 16 3 11 16 4 5 16 8-10 4 11 16 5 3 8 3 9 16 4-6 4 1 16 4 9 16 8-10 5 5 5 8 6 1 2 8 1 8
E Figs. 174,181
2 1 8 2 3 4 3 5 16 2 1 4 2 7 8 3 1 2 2
7 16
Pipe Size
3/ 4
Fig. No.
160 161 162 160
Max Load s
1,200
Weight
1.4 2.1 2.8 1.4
Figs. 174,181
2 1 2 3 1 2 5 3 4 5 3 5 6 3 1 2 5 6 8 4 5 6 8 5 6 8 10 5 6 8 10 6 8 10 6 8 10
161 162 160 161 162 163 160 161 162 163 160 161
1,200
2.1 2.8 1.4 2.1 2.8 3.6 1.5 2.1 3.2 3.6 1.7 2.3
1 1 4
1,200
3 1 16 3 5 8 4 3 8 2 5 8 3 1 4 4 4 5 8 2 15 16 3 1 2 4 1 4 4 13 16 5 3 8 3 1 4 4 4 5 8 5 1 8 5 3 4 3 1 2 4 5 16 4 13 16 5 7 16 6 4 4 9 16 5 1 8 5 5 8 6 5 16 4 1 4 4 7 8 5 3 8 5 15 16 6 9 16 7 5 8 9 1 2
1 1 2
1,200
1,200
2 1 2
1,200
1,200
3 1 2
162 163 164 160 161 162 163 164 165 165A 166A
1,200
3.6 4.5 4.9 2.3 3.2 3.6 4.5 4.9 6.1 11.6 15.7
1,200
10 14
12 16
7,200
12-14
s Maximum recommended loads are applicable only when saddle is used on a at bearing surface and tack welded to pipe. When saddle is used with a pipe roll, the maximum load for the assembly is the smaller of the two loads. Saddles may require notching when used with a U-bolt.
PH 109
Return to TOC
PROTECTION SADDLES
Fig. 160 to Fig 166A Pipe Covering Protection Saddle (cont.)
Fig. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, 165, 165A, 166A: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Size of Pipe Roll Figs. 271, 274, 277
4-6
Center Line of Pipe to Center Line of Roll Center Line of Pipe to Outside of Saddle C
4 1 8 4 11 16 5 3 16 8-10 5 5 8 6 3 16 12-14 4-6 8-10 8-10 7 1 8 8 11 16 4 1 2 5 1 16 5 1 2 6 3 16 6 9 16 12-14 16-20 8-10 12-14 16-20 810 12-14 7 9 16 7 5 8 9 1 8 6 6 1 2 7 1 4 7 11 16 8 11 16 10 1 4 7 1 4 7 5 8 8 1 8 8 11 16 16-20 22-24 12-14 9 3 4 9 11 16 11 1 8 8 1 16 8 5 8 9 1 8 16-20 9 5 8 10 1 3 1 6 11 22-24 12-14 16-20 12 5 1 6 8 3 4 9 5 16 9 7 8 10 5 1 6 11 5 1 6 22-24 11 9 1 6 12 7 8
E Figs. 174,181
4 13 16 5 1 2 6 1 16 6 9 16 7 1 4 8 3 8 10 1 1 6 5 3 8 5 11 16 6 7 16 7 3 16 7 5 8 9
9 16
Pipe Size
Fig. No.
160 161 162 163 164 165 165A 166A 160 161 162 163 164 165 165A 166A 161 162 163
Max Load s
Weight
2.3 3.2 3.6 4.5 4.9 6.1 11.6 15.7 3.8 4.4 5.7 6.5 7.7 10.2 12.9 16.3 5.8 6.3
Figs. 174,181
8 10
1,200
10 12 16 8 10 12 14 16 10 12 14 16 18 12 14 16 18 20 14 16 18 20 24 16 18 20 24
12 14 16 8 10 12 16 18 12 14 16 18 20 14 16 18 20 16 18 20 18 20
7,200
1,800
7,200
7 1 16 7 9 16 8 1 2 9 10 1 8 11 1 3 1 6 8 1 2 9 9 9 16 10 1 1 6 11 1 4 9 1 2 10 1 1 6 10 9 1 6 11 1 8 10 1 8 10 1 3 1 6 11 3 8 11 3 4
1,800
10
12
14
s Maximum recommended loads are applicable only when saddle is used on a at bearing surface and tack welded to pipe. When saddle is used with a pipe roll, the maximum load for the assembly is the smaller of the two loads.
PH 110
Return to TOC
PROTECTION SADDLES
Pipe Covering Protection Saddle (cont.)
Center Line of Pipe to Center Line of Roll Center Line of Pipe to Outside of Saddle C
9 13 16 16-20 10 3 1 6 10 1 3 1 6 11 1 1 6 22-24 26-30 16-20 12 3 1 6 12 7 1 6 13 1 3 1 6 10 1 3 1 6 11 5 1 6 11 5 8 22-24 12 1 4 13 5 1 6 13 3 4 26-30 14 7 8 11 5 8 22-24 12 1 4 12 3 4 13 5 1 6 14 1 8 26-30 14 3 8 16 1 8 13 1 2 14 14 5 8 26-30 15 1 4 16 7 1 6 16 1 1 1 6 18 16 1 5 1 6 17 1 2 18 1 1 6 36-42 18 5 8 19 1 1 1 6 19 1 5 1 6 21 1 2 20 1 4 20 1 5 1 6 2 15 16 36-42 21 7 8 22 7 8 23 1 8 24 5 8
Fig. 160, 161, 162, 163, 164, 165, 165A, 166A: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Size of Pipe Roll Figs. 271, 274, 277
E Figs. 174,181
11 1 4 11 3 4
Pipe Size
Fig. No.
161 162 163
Max Load s
5,000
Weight
8.4 10.4 11.1 13.3 15.3
Figs. 174,181
20
16
7,200
11,140 5,000
30.1 40.0 9.1 10.4 12.4 13.3 15.3 40.3 52.1 10.4 11.6 30 24
18
7,200
13,370
7,200
24
20
30
24
30
30
36
s Maximum recommended loads are applicable only when saddle is used on a at bearing surface and tack welded to pipe. When saddle is used with a pipe roll, the maximum load for the assembly is the smaller of the two loads.
PH 111
21 1 2
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Fig. 177
Size Range: 1" through 30" Material: Cast iron roll and sockets; steel roll rod, continuous thread
rods and hex nuts
Finish: Plain Service: For support of pipe where horizontal movement due to
expansion and contraction will occur and where vertical adjustment up to 6" may be necessary.
Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 41)
WW-H-171-E (Type 42) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 41).
How to size:
(1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page PH-108 for size of pipe roll. (3) If roll is to support covered pipe, the O.D. of the covering should not be greater than the O.D. of the pipe for which the roll was designed.
Ordering: Specify size of roll, gure number and name. Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles makes this necessary.
Weight
1. 1 1.2 1.2 1. 3 2.3 2. 4 2.7 3. 8 4. 7 7. 6
B
3
C
1 1 2 17 8 2 1 8 2 5 8 3 1 8 3 3 4 4 1 4 4 3 4 5 13 16 67 8 87 8 11 12 1 2 14 1 4 16 1 4 18 1 4 20 1 4 24 1 4 30 1 4
H
1 1 16 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 15 16 2 1 4
1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12
3 8
3 3 8 3 5 8 4 1 8 47 8
1 2
5 1 2 6 1 8
5 8
6 3 4 8 1 16 9 9 16 11
15 16
12
2 9 16 2 13 16 3 7 16 4 5 1 8 6 3 8 7 7 16 8 3 8 9 7 16
3 4
14 1 1 6 15 1 3 1 6 17 3 4 19 3 4 21 7 8 24 1 4 28 5 8 35 1 2
v B v
14 16 18 20 24 30
18
10 1 2 11 5 8
24
14 17 7 1 6
PH 112
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Single Pipe Roll
Adjustment: Adjustable socket permits vertical adjustment at the roll. Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller How to size:
(1) If the roll is to support non-insulated pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (column 1) in table below. (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page PH-108 for size of pipe roll.
Features: Provides for vertical adjustment; nut at bottom of hanger rod ts into the socket
preventing loosening or turning due to vibration.
C L
v A v v v v v
v E F
D C B G
Rod Size A
Max Load
Weight
0.45
G
4 1 8 4 1 2 4 3 4 5 1 4 6 1 4 6 7 8 7 1 2 8 1 4 9 11 16 1 1 7 16 1 4 1 16 1 6 3 16 2 0 1 8 2 2 1 8 2 4 1 2 2 7 1 4 3 2 1 8 39
B
3 3 3 8 3 5 8 4 1 8 4 7 8 5 1 2 6 1 8 6 3 4 8 1 16 9 9 16 1 1 15 16 1 4 1 16 1 7 3 4 1 9 3 4 2 1 7 8 2 4 1 4 2 8 5 8 3 5 1 2
C
1 1 2 1 7 8 2 1 8 2 5 8 3 1 8 3 3 4 4 1 4 4 3 4 5 13 16 6 7 8 8 7 8 11 1 2 1 2 1 4 1 4 1 6 1 4 1 8 1 4 2 0 1 4 2 4 1 4 3 0 1 4
D
1 1 1 16 1 1 8 1 3 16 1 3 8 1 7 16 1 5 8 1 3 4 2 2 5 16 2 13 16 3 3 8 3 7 8 4 5 8 5 5 7 16 6 7 3 16 8 15 16
3 8
600
0.48 0.51 0.57 1.00 1.10 1.40 1.70 2.60 4.50 7.20 9.50 15.90 24.30 31.90 35.50 47.00 76.30 129.90
3 4
3 8
1 1 4 1 3 8 1 5 8 1 15 16
9 16
660
1 2
700 750 1,070 1,350 1,730 2,400 3,130 3,970 4,200 4,550 6,160 7,290
7 8 1 2
2 1 4 2 9 16 2 13 16 3 7 16 4 5 1 8 6 3 8 7 7 16 8 3 8 9 7 16 1 0 1 2 1 1 5 8 14 1 7 7 16
11 16
1 1 1 8 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 2 2 5 8 2 3 4 3 3 5 8 4 1 2 1 1 2 1 3 4 1 1 4
5 8 3 4 7 8
3 4 7 8
5 8
3 4
1 1 1 8 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 1 2 1 5 8 1 3 4 2 7 16
7 8
1 1 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
PH 113
Pipe Roll
1 7 15 16 1 5 13 16
Pipe roll is designed for two point surface contact with pipe or saddle. Ordering: Specify pipe roll size. Order should include gure number, name and nish in all cases. Hanger rods
v J
v v v
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Fig. 178
Material: Spring cushion hanger Fig. 178 consists of a set of two
springs and four cast iron retainers only.
Finish: Plain (retainers), Painted (springs) Service: Generally used with Fig. 171 single pipe roll as shown in
above photo. Recommended for installations where formal load and movement calculations are not required, or calculated movement does not exceed 14"
Ordering: Specify gure number, name and rod size. If used with Fig. 171 single pipe roll, pipe roll must be ordered separately. The retainers are cased to the dimensions as shown, but center hole can be drilled or reamed larger to satisfy the hanger rod required.
C L
Spring No.
1 2 3
Fig. 178: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Deection Rate of Hanger (lbs / inch)
428 1,200 2,400
1 1 4
1,500 3,000
* At maximum recommended deection, spring can be compressed an additional 1 4 " before becoming solid. s Maximum capacity of double spring hanger. ** Can be drilled to max. rod size.
PH 114
v v
Weight
4.5 14.0 22.0
C
2 21 32 4 1 8 4 1 8
D
6 7 16 6 1 16 9 1 16
7 8
1 1 2
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Adjustable Steel Yoke Pipe Roll
Fig. 181
Size Range: 2 1 2 " through 24" Material: Cast iron roll; carbon steel yoke, roll rod and hex nuts Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For suspension of pipe from a single rod where horizontal
movement may occur because of expansion or contraction.
Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 43)
WW-H-171-E (Type 44) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 43).
How to size: If the roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from
nominal pipe size (see below). If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page PH-108 for size of pipe roll to be used.
Ordering: Specify pipe roll size, gure number, name and nish. Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required.
A v
D v v
Fig. 181: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
Max Load
225 310 390 475 685 780 965 1,200 1,400 1,600 1,800
Weight
1.7 2.2 2.5 3.2 6.3 9.3 14.5 18.8 27.7 39.1 49.1 57.8 75.9 119.3
Rod Size A
1 2
B
5 3 4 6 3 8 7 7 9 16 9 1 8 10 5 1 6 12 1 1 1 6 15 1 1 6 17 7 1 6 18 7 8 20 1 3 1 6 23 3 4 26 32 5 1 6
C
3 1 4 37 8 4 3 8 4
15 16
5 8
6 7 1 8 9 1 4 11 1 4 13 1 4 14 1 2 16 1 2 18 1 2 20 1 2 24 5 8
3 4
7 8
7 7 16 8 3 8 9 3 8 10 7 1 6 11 5 8 13 15 16
8 3 8 8 3 4 9 11 16 11 7 1 6 12 1 4 15 3 4
2 1 4 2 1
15 16
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
2 13 16 2 1 2 4 3 8
PH 115
Pipe Roll
E C L B
D
1 15 16 2 1 4 2 9 16 2 13 16 3 7 16 4 5 1 8 6 3 8
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Fig. 175
Size Range: 2" through 30" pipe Material: Cast iron roll, steel chair, roll rod, bolts and hex nuts Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller Service: For support of pipe where longitudinal movement due to expansion
and contraction may occur, but where no vertical adjustment is required.
Roller Chair
Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 44) WW-H-171-E (Type 45) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 44). Installation: Two bolts and nuts provide anchorage to oor or top of
steel beam or bracket or chair may be welded to supporting steel.
How to size:
(1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page PH-108 for size of pipe roll. (3) If roll is to support covered pipe, the O.D. of the covering should not be greater than the O.D. of the pipe for which the roll was designed.
C L v
Ordering: Specify size of roll, gure number, name and nish. Be certain to
order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required.
W v v
C v
Fig. 175: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 1,070 1,350 1,730 2,400 3,130 3,970 4,200 4,550 6,160 7,290 750
Max Load
600 660 700
Weight
1.1 1.4 1.6 2.6 2.9 3.9 5.9 9.0 13.8 18.9 28.07 34.93 44.35 56.34 87.52 151.25
W
4 47 8 5 3 8 6 1 8 6 5 8 77 8 9 1 4 11 5 8 14 1 8 16 1 8 18 3 4 21 23 1 8 24 5 8 29 3 8 34 1 3 1 6
B
1 1 4
C
1 1 2 1 5 8 1 3 4 2 1 16 2 5 16 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 5 8 4 1 8 4 11 16 5 3 8 6 6 1 2 77 8 8 3 4
7 8 3 4 5 8 1 2
3 8 x
1 1 2
2 3 3 1 8 3 3 8 5 1 4 5 1 2 6 1 2 8 1 4 9 1 4 10 1 4 12 1 4 15 3 8
x 1 1 2 x 1 1 2 x 2 x 2 2 1 2
5 8 3 4
x 3 1 2
PH 116
v
v
H
1 5 8 1 15 16 2 1 4 2 9 16 2 13 16 3 7 16 4 5 1 8 6 3 8 7 7 16 8 3 8 9 3 8 10 7 1 6 11 5 8 14 17 7 1 6
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Pipe Roll and Base Plate
Fig. 277: With Cast Iron Base Plate Fig. 277S: With Steel Base Plate
Size Range: 2" through 24" Material: Cast iron roll and plate Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For support of pipe where small longitudinal movement due
to expansion and contraction may occur and where no vertical adjustment is required.
Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 45)
WW-H-171-E (Type 46) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 45).
How to size:
(1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page PH-108 for size of pipe roll.
Features: An economical, practical means of supporting pipe with limited horizontal movement due to expansion and contraction. Ordering: Specify pipe roll size, gure number, name and nish. Be
certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required
C L
Note: Fabricated carbon steel base plates for extended travel are
available upon request.
v E v
v
v
TRAVERSE v B v K D J v v v A H G v
v v
Pipe Size
2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24
Fig. 277, Fig. 277S: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Weight Max A B D E G H Load Fig. 277 Fig. 277S
3 1 4 390 4.0 3.3 3 1 2 3 13 16 4 1 16 4 5 16 950 5.6 4.5 4
15 16
1 3 4 2 1 8 2 3 8 2 5 8 2 3 4 3 3 8 4 5 1 4 6 3 8 7 1 2 8 1 8 9 3 8 10 3 8 11 3 8 13 3 8 13 1 4 9 1 2 4 7 16 7 5 8 1 5 3 4 12 8 1 2 4 1 2 6 3 8
7 8
4 3 4
2 5 8
17 8
1 3 4
1 2
5 3 4
3 5 8
2 1 16
2 5 8
1 2
1 1 2
5 1 2 2,100 3,075 15.3 27.9 10.9 19.4 7 9 16 8 11 16 10 1 4 10 7 8 12 3 8 4,980 6,100 43.7 51.5 31 37 13 1 2 14 1 2 16 5 8
8 1 4 10 3 4
5 5 8 7 5 8
3 1 4 4
4 5 5 8
11 16
2 1 2 4
3 4
PH 117
Pipe Roll
v v
K D
v v
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Fig. 271: Complete
Size Range: 2" through 42" Material: Cast iron roll and stand Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For support of pipe where longitudinal movement due to expansion
and contraction may occur but where no vertical adjustment is required.
Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 44)
WW-H-171-E (Type 45) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 44).
Installation:
(1) Two cored holes K for anchorage bolts are provided on all sizes or fastening stands to welded stands, to welded steel brackets, structural supports, piers, oors, etc. (2) In addition, cored holes N at the four corners of the stand are provided for anchorage purposes. (3) The two cored holes K on sizes 2 to 6" are on outside of stand (see dotted lines and dimension J). (4) On all other sides, the holes K are inside of uprights (see dimension J).
v v
v
v v J v G N v v
v
How to size: If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal
pipe size (see below).
v C L v D F v B v v v v H
1"
T J' v
D'
to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddle are required.
v M v v
U E
Fig. 271: Weight (lbs) Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36 42 6,100 7,500 12,000 49.6 99.3 152.0 4,980 39.7 2,100 3,075 15.3 28.1 950 8.9 390 6.4
H
3 1 2 3 7 8 4 1 8 4 3 8 4 13 16 5 7 16 6 1 16 8 11 16 9 13 16 1 1 3 8 12 1 3 5 8 1 4 5 8 1 5 5 8 1 7 3 4 2 1 7 8 2 5 3 4 2 8 7 8
B
1 3 8 2 1 8 2 3 8 2 5 8 2 3 4 3 3 8 4 5 1 4 6 3 8 7 1 2 8 1 8 9 3 8
D'
J'
8 3 8
5 3 8
2 3 4
1 7 8
6 3 8
9 16
11 16 1 2
3 7 16
5 3 8
9 7 8
5 5 8
3 3 4
2 1 16
7 7 8
3 4 7 8
4 11 16 4 1 4
7 3 4 9 7 8
6 5 8 7 7 8
6 8
3 1 4 4
4 5 3 4
5 8
8 5 8
5 6
3 4
1 0 15 16 9 1 16
1 0 3 8 1 1 1 4 1 1 3 8 1 3 3 8 1 2 1 2 1 6 3 4 20 2 0 1 8 1 5 3 4 1 8 3 4
8 5 8
9 10
4 1 2
6 3 4
7 8
1 1 1 8 1 1 2
13 16
1 2 3 8 1 3 1 2
1 0 1 4 1 1 3 8 1 4 1 4 17
6 1 2
4 7 16 7 1 2 5 1 2 6 3 8 10 12
1 1 1 4
1 0 3 4 12
1 2 1 2 15
1 1 16
17 20
8 9
1 1 2 1 3 4 1 5 16
PH 118
Ordering: Specify pipe roll size, gure number, name and nish. Be certain
v
v
v v
Return to TOC
PIPE ROLL
Adjustable Pipe Roll Stand
Fig. 274: With Base Plate; Fig. 275: W/O Base Plate Fig. 274P: Base Plate Only Steel
Size Range: 2" through 42" Material: Cast iron base plate, stand roll; steel adjusting screws Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For support of pipe lines where longitudinal movement due to
expansion and contraction may occur and where vertical and lateral adjustment during installation may be required.
Maximum Temperature: 450 F at roller Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 46)
WW-H-171-E (Type 47) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 46).
Installation: Base plate is provided with two holes for anchorage to oor, pier, structural support and similar constructions, as well as to welded steel brackets Fig. 195 page PH-66 and Fig. 199, page PH-67. Adjustable pipe roll stand without base plate, Fig. 275, can be used for supporting tunnel piping, etc., by resting ends of adjusting screws on structural steel angles, channels, etc. Adjustment: Vertical adjustment is obtained by use of the four adjusting screws
located on corners of stand. Lateral adjustment is secured by stand sliding on each of adjusting screws.
Outside Holes Only on Sizes 2 " to 6" v v v J v v D F v C L T J' v D' v
How to size:
(1) If roll is to support bare pipe, select the size directly from nominal pipe size (see below). (2) If used with pipe covering protection saddle, see page PH-108 for size of pipe roll.
M' v v v v
T J W
v v
U E'
v v P
Fig. 274, 275, 274P: Dimensions (in) Weight H' M' H' W E' K Fig. Fig. Fig. Min Max Max 274 275 274P
51 8 53 8 55 8 6 61 4 7 71 2 81 8 115 8 123 4 141 4 147 8 165 8 173 4 183 4 21 263 4 213 4 347 8 153 4 191 4 23 101 2 11 11 8 31 4 41 2 145 8 85 8 17 8 105 8 13 63 4 8 1 13 4 81 8 53 4 11 8 67 8 51 2
7 8
2 1 2
3 31 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36 42
390
15.2
7.8
15.3
3 4
5 8
950
19.3
10.3
19.3
2,100 3,075
32.1 51.2
18.1 32.1
32.1 51.2
13 16
3 4
11 8
3 4 7 8
71.3 87.0
45.3 55.0
11 4 13 8 15 8 2
7 8
1 3 16
13 8 21 4
1 11 4 11 2 11 4 11 2
PH 119
Pipe Roll
dimensions of stand, see Fig. 271, page PH-118. Be certain to order oversized rolls when insulation and protection saddles are required.
G S N'
Ordering: Specify pipe roll size, gure number, name and nish. For further
B H'
v v v v v
v
v v
Return to TOC
PIPE GUIDE
Fig. 255
Size Range: 1" through 24" pipe and insulation thickness of 1" through 4"
(Also available in copper tube sizes, see page PH-20)
Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For maintaining alignment of piping through its axial expansion and contraction
cycles. Normally, two or more pipe alignment guides are used on a single piping run to avoid a pivoting effect within the piping system. It is recommended that the rst guide be located a maximum of four pipe diameters from an expansion joint. The second guide should be placed a maximum of 18 pipe diameters from an expansion joint. Additional guides should be employed in accordance with the guide spacing data shown on next page. Supports are usually required between the intermediate guides to comply with standard support practice.
Note: Spider attachments to pipe must be properly located during installation to insure that a minimum of one-half the spider width remains within the length of the outer housing for all conditions of operation. See W table on opposite page for maximum recommended travels. v If larger travels are required, special guides can be furnished to special order.
v
v v
PIPE
T v v F G v v v v L v v v v C
v
v
v H DIA 4 HOLES E v
J INSULATION THICKNESS
L (in)
4 6 8
Maximum Movement
4 6 8
B C L
T v v v v
v
H DIA E v v
4 HOLES
J INSULATION THICKNESS
PH 120
v D
PIPE
F G
v v
Return to TOC
PIPE GUIDE
Pipe Alignment Guide (cont.)
Fig. 255
Dimensions (in) W
8 13 16 10 1 3 1 6 13 5 1 6 15 7 8 18 22 1 4 28 32 3 8 37 5 8
B
6 3 4 8 3 4 11 1 4 13 3 8 15 1 2 19 3 4 25 29 1 4 34 1 2
C
8 7 8 9 7 8 12 7 1 6 14 1 3 1 6 17 1 1 6 21 1 1 6 26 1 4 30 3 4 36 1 8
D
4 5 16 5 5 16 6 5 8 7
15 16
E
6 3 4 7 3 8 7 7 8 9 3 4
5 8
1 4
2 1 2
4
3 4 5 16
D E F
9 1 8 11 13 9 1 6 15 7 8 18 5 8 14 1 8 4 6 1
3 8
G H J
15 7 8 16 3 8 5 1 2 17 1 8 8
H J
100
27 37 47 62 75 85 87 95 105 110 128
150
22 32 40 51 62 70 72 78 87 92 105
200
20 27 35 45 54 60 62 68 75 90 90
250
18 25 31 40 50 55 57 61 68 73 83
300
17 23 28 36 45 50 52 57 62 68 75
350
15 22 27 35 42 46 48 52 58 62 70
400
14 19 25 32 40 43 45 49 55 58 65
500
13 17 23 29 35 40 41 45 50 53 60
600
12 16 20 27 32 35 37 41 45 49 54
* For pipe sizes not shown refer to the Expansion Joint Manufacturers Association Guidelines
PH 121
Return to TOC
PIPE GUIDE
Fig. 256
Size Range: 1" through 24" pipe and insulation thickness of 1" through 4" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Service: For maintaining alignment of piping through its axial expansion and
contraction cycles. Normally, two or more pipe alignment guides are used on a single piping run to avoid a pivoting effect within the piping system. It is recommended that the rst guide be located a maximum of four pipe diameters from an expansion joint. The second guide should be placed a maximum of 18 pipe diameters from the expansion joint. Additional guides should be employed in accordance with the guide spacing data on next page. Supports are usually required between the intermediate guides to comply with standard support practice.
Note: Spider attachments to pipe must be properly located during installation to insure that a minimum of one-half the spider width remains within the length of the outer housing for all conditions of operation. See table on opposite page for maximum recommended travels. If larger travels are required, special guides can be furnished to special order. How to size: Size by nominal pipe size and insulation thickness in accordance with
the selection table on opposite page.
L (in)
6 8 10
Maximum Movement
6 8 10
Ordering: Specify size number, pipe size, insulation thickness, gure number,
name and nish.
Caution: Guides are designed to carry 20% of the dead weight load.
W
v
C L
v
D
PIPE
v
H DIA 4 HOLES
J INSULATION THICKNESS
PH 122
T
F G
Return to TOC
PIPE GUIDE
Pipe Alignment Guide (cont.)
Fig. 256
112
A A A B B B B C C D E F F
2
A A A B B B B C C D E F F G G
212
B B B B B C C C D D E F F G G
3
B B B C C C C C D E E F F G G H H J
4
C C C C D D D D E E F F G G G H H J
Dimensions (in) W
8 13 16 10 1 3 1 6 13 3 4 15 7 8 18 22 1 4 28 32 3 8 37 5 8
B
6 3 4 8 3 4 11 1 4
C
7 7 8 9 7 8 12 7 1 6
D
4 5 16 5 5 16 6 5 8
E
6 3 4 7 3 8 7 7 8 9 3 4 14 1 8 15 7 8 16 3 8 17 1 8
F
2 1 2
G
4
5 8
1 4
13 3 8 14 1 3 1 6 7 15 16 15 1 2 19 3 4 25 29 1 4 34 1 2 17 1 1 6 21 1 1 6 26 1 4 30 3 4 36 1 8 9 1 8 11 13 9 1 6 15 7 8 18 5 8
3 4
5 16
5 1 2
3 8
100
27 37 47 62 75 85 87 95 105 110 128
150
22 32 40 51 62 70 72 78 87 92 105
200
20 27 35 45 54 60 62 68 75 90 90
250
18 25 31 40 50 55 57 61 68 73 83
300
17 23 28 36 45 50 52 57 62 68 75
350
15 22 27 35 42 46 48 52 58 62 70
400
14 19 25 32 40 43 45 49 55 58 65
500
13 17 23 29 35 40 41 45 50 53 60
600
12 16 20 27 32 35 37 41 45 49 54
* For pipe sizes not shown refer to the Expansion Joint Manufacturers Association Guidelines
PH 123
Return to TOC
PIPE SLIDES
PTFE Pipe Slide Assemblies
Application
Anvil PTFE pipe slide assemblies are designed to support the pipe and provide for lateral and axial movement due to thermal expansion and contraction of the piping system. Assemblies are fabricated using PTFE slide bearings to provide a low coefcient of friction, minimizing frictional stress on the pipe and support structure.
Overview
Features Pre-engineered to save calculation and installation time. PTFE slide bearing pads are composed of 100% virgin
Polytetrauoroethylene polymer.
Capable of supporting constant loads up to 2000 PSI at 70 F The low 0.2 coefcient of friction for the PTFE slide assemblies
permits a smooth, unrestrained movement of the pipe and reduces overturning movements on supporting structures.
Maximum temperature: 400 F at PTFE Allows for up to 4" insulation thickness as standard. Greater
than 4" insulation available on special request. Special designed slides and tees available on request.
The maximum load on the pipe slides is based on using a PTFE width of 2" for the slide plate and a 70 F temperature. For a different temperature at the bearing surfaces, multiply the maximum load rating by the following factor Temperature F
70 100 200 300 400
Factor
1.00 0.85 0.55 0.40 0.25
Selection
(1) Determine the support location based on allowable span and loading conditions. (2) Calculate the load for each slide assembly location. (3) Determine the lateral and axial movement of the pipe and the direction of movement, cold to hot. (4) Select pipe slide or tee gure number and attachment conguration, welded or bolted. (5) Select the method of slide plate attachment to support structure, welded or bolted. (6) Designate whether guided or non-guided slide plate is required. (7) Maximum recommended loads shown for pipe slides and structural tees are for vertical loading. Transitional loads for pipe structural tees are to be determined by customer.
Installation
(1) Determine offset of pipe slide-slide plate interface to allow maximum pipe movement in direction of greatest thermal displacement. (2) Attach PTFE slide to pipe by welding or clamping with standard Fig. 212 pipe clamp or Fig. 432 special pipe clamp. (3) Attach slide plates to supporting structure by bolting or welding. (4) Verify setting to insure full bearing between the PTFE slide and slide base surfaces under all pipe movement conditions.
PH 124
Return to TOC
PIPE SLIDES
Pipe Slides Assembly, Complete
Fig. 257: Structural Tee Slide Assembly Fig. 257A: Structural Tee Fig. 436: Fabricated Tee Slide Assembly Fig. 436A: Fabricated Tee
Size Range: All sizes within maximum load rating. Material: Carbon steel tee, PTFE bonded slide plates and
carbon steel base.
Finish: Plain, Painted or Galvanized Service: For the support of piping where horizontal movement
resulting from expansion and contraction takes place and where a low coefcient of friction is desired.
v
Fig 257
Fig 436
Maximum Temperature: 750 F Temperature Range at PTFE: -20 F to 400 F Features: No lubrication required. Designed to minimize heat loss. Allows up to 3 of insulation. Allows up to 10 travel standard Weld in place design. Available Options: Increased travels. Increased Tee heights. End plates. Clamps, Fig. 212 or Fig. 432. Base plate with mounting holes Ordering: Specify gure number, type, name, nish and any other
option desired.
Figure Number
Fig. 257, 436: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) Weights (lbs) Max Load Welded Slide Bolted Slide Type
Tee 1 2 3 4 5 6 Tee
PTFE Slide
Down
Side *
Up
800 800
H**
31516 4 3 4 5 4 3 4 5
W
4 3 1 2 8 5 1 2 1112
BL
12 2 4 2 4
H**
4 3 4 5 4 3 4 5 41116 41516 41116 41516
W
8
BL
Hole Locations
2 1 2 x 6 1 2
Weight
7.0 12.0 16.4 17.4 16.5 17.4 19.3 8.0 12.0 16.4 17.4 16.5 17.4 19.3
Fig. 257
8,000
2,000 2,000
4 1112 8 4 1112 3 x 9 1 2 3 x 9 1 2 2 1 2 x 6 1 2
12 3 5 8 4 2 1 4732 2 8 4 2,000 4716 8,000 Fig. 436 3 800 4 6 2 4732 5 4 2,000 4716 1112 6 800 * Side load is only applicable if appropriate endplates are added to slide or T Section ** With clamps; add material thickness of a gure 212 or gure 432.
PH 125
Return to TOC
PIPE SLIDES
Fig. 257 and 436 PTFE Pipe Slide Assemblies
Notes: Types 1, 2, and 3 provide for longitudinal movement only. Types 4, 5, and 6 provide for both longitudinal and transverse movement of piping.
Type 1
Fig 257, Type 1
v
Type 2
Fig 257, Type 2
v
116
3 8
Type 3
Fig 257, Type 3
Type 4
H 1"
v
v
1"
Type 5
Fig 257, Type 5
Type 6
v
PIPE FIELD WELDED TO TEE
v
v
Note: Gap is larger than Type 2
1"
3 8
1"
1"
FIG.435 NOTCHED TO REDUCE HEAT LOSS FIG.257 FEATURES LINE CONTACT WITH PIPE
BL 12"
PH 126
v
W
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
v
Return to TOC
PIPE SLIDES
Structural H Slide Assembly, Complete
PTFE Pipe Slide Assembly "H" Type
Fig. 439
Size Range: 6" through 36" Material: Carbon steel H section, PTFE bonded slide plates and
carbon steel base.
Finish: Plain, Painted or Galvanized Service: A heavy duty slide support where horizontal movement
resulting from expansion and contraction takes place and where a low coefcient of friction is desired.
Structural "H"
Mounting Plate
Maximum Temperature: 750 F Temperature Range at PTFE: -20 F to 400 F Features: No lubrication required. Allows up to 4" of insulation. Allows up to 10" travel standard. Weld in place design. Available Options: Increased travels. Increased H Section heights. Clamps, Fig. 212 or Fig. 432. Base plate with mounting holes Ordering: Specify gure number, type, name, nish and any
other option desired.
PTFE Slides
Fig. 439: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) W Pipe Size 1
6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36 12 14 16 18 161 2 181 2 21 23 14 16 18 20 10 14 12 51 8 53 8 5 7 16 6 8 8
B Type 5
12
H* Type 3
5 5 16
BL Type
Weight Type 1
19.3
Type 2&3
10
4
8
1&4 2&5
5 51 4
1&4 2&5
73 4 83 4 95 8 103 4 107 8 121 8 125 8 133 4 8 9 97 8 11 111 8 123 8 127 8 14 157 8 197 8 231 4
3
8 1 16 9 1 16 9 15 16 1 1 1 16 113 16 1 2 7 16 1 2 15 16 1 4 1 16 1 5 15 16 2 0 1 16 2 3 7 16
1 & 4 2, 3, & 5
2
27.8
3
29.8
4
19.7
5
29.5
1 2 , 0 0 0 3,000 1 , 2 0 0
12
10
14
24.7 6 2
34.5
36.4
25.1
36.1
161 2
16,000
4,000
1,600
28.1
39.1
41.6
28.6
41.0
181 2 21 23 25 51 4 61 4 6 7 16 51 2 65 8 6 13 16 5 9 16 611 16 63 4
155 8 195 8 23
* With clamps; add material thickness of a Fig. 212. * With continuous clamp; add material thickness of Fig. 432
PH 127
Return to TOC
PIPE SLIDES
Fig. 439 PTFE Pipe Slide Assemblies
Notes: Types 1, 2, and 3 provide for longitudinal movement only. Types 4 and 5 provide for both longitudinal and transverse movement of piping.
Type 1
C L
Type 2
C L
v
H B
v
3 8
Type 3
C L
Type 4
C L
v
v
H B
HOLD-DOWN LUGS
116
1"
3 8
Type 5
C L
v
v
H
B
1"
v
v
3 8
v
v
BL 12"
PH 128
1"
v v
vv
v v
v
v
v
116
v v
vv
v
v v
Return to TOC
Fig. 432
Size Range: 2" through 24" Material: Carbon steel Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: Plain 750 F, Galvanized 450 F
for carbon steel pipe only
Service: Used with and where pipe slides cannot be welded directly to pipe or copper tube. When used with berglass, plastic, or aluminum pipe, a thin protective liner should be inserted between the pipe and the clamp. Clamp is designed for use with Figure 257 and Figures 436 and 439 slides and tees. Ordering: Specify gure number, pipe size, name and nish.
v P
v
v
M
5 5 1 2 6 6 1 2 7 8 9 5 8 11 5 8 13 3 4 15 3 4 17 7 8 19 7 8 21 7 8 23 7 8 28 1 8
N
4 4 1 2 5 5 1 2 6 7 8 1 2 10 1 2 12 5 8 14 5 8 16 1 2 18 1 2 20 1 2 22 1 2 26 7 8
Weight
2 3 3 4 4 5
1 4
4 1 2
3 8
15 6 18 21 41 46 8 52 57 67
1 2
5 8
PH 129
12
Return to TOC
F
v v
Fig. 257 w/Fig 212 Clamps
C L
B
2 1 8 2 1 2 2 13 16 3 3 16 3 7 16 4 3 16 4 7 8 6 7 7 16 8 7 16 9 1 4 10 1 4 11 5 8 12 3 4 15 1 4 19
C
1 2
D
2 3 4 3 1 8 3 7 16 3 13 16 4 3 16 4 15 16 53 4 67 8 8 9 16 9 9 16 10 5 8 12 1 8 13 14 1 8 16 7 8 21 1 8
H
2 3 4 3 1 4 3 9 16 3 13 16 4 3 8 4 15 16 57 8 7 8 9 16 9 9 16 10 5 8 12 1 8 13 14 1 8 16 7 8 21 1 8
Weight
1.1 1.2 1.4 1.5 2.3 2.6 5.4 6.5 13.6 15.2 20.5 22.3 31.6 35.8 53.1 113.9
5 8
1 2
3 4 7 8
5 8
3 4
7 8
1 1 8 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 5 8 2
1 1 1 8 1 1 4 1 3 4
PH 130
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Light-Duty Spring Hanger
Spring Hangers
Rod Size A
38
Fig. 247
Finish: Painted Service: Recommended for light loads where vertical movement does not
exceed 11 4 ".
Approvals: WW-H-171E (Type 49) and MSS-SP-69 (Type 48). Installation: Designed for attachment to its supporting member by
screwing a rod into the top cap of the hanger the full depth of the cap. Incorporates a convenient load coupling to facilitate proper adjustment during installation.
C E B
1 2 "
114" MAX.
Fig. 247: Loads (lbs) Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Size No.
1 2 3 4 114
Max Deection*
Max Load
47.5 85.0 150.0 267.0
Weight
1.4 1.6 3.1 4.5
Shipping Length B
458 51932 51116 714
Casing Length C
418 5332 5316 634
Casing Diam D
134 212
12
PH 131
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Fig. 82, Fig. B-268, Fig. 98, Triple Spring, and Quadruple Spring Fig. C-82, Fig. C-268, Fig. C-98, Triple-CR, and Quadruple-CR Spring (Corrosion Resistant)
Design features: Precompression.
Precompressing the spring into the hanger casing provides the following advantages: (1) Saves up to 50% in headroom by reducing the length of the hanger. (2) Reduces the installed height of the overall hanger assembly. (3) Prevents the spring supporting force from exceeding the normal safe limits of variations. (4) Saves valuable erection time because spring is precompressed close to 1 2 " of the working range.
Fig. 98
Calibration: all Anvil Variable Spring Hangers and supports are calibrated for accurate loading conditions. Load indicator is clearly seen in the slot, simplifying reading of the scale plate. Load is read from bottom of indicator. Cold set at the factory upon request. Spring and casing are fabricated of steel and are rugged and compact. Piston cap serves as a centering device or guide maintaining spring alignment.
Approvals: WW-H-171E (Types 51, 56 and 57) and MSS-SP-69 (Types 51, 52 and 53). Specications: Anvil Variable Spring Hangers are welded in strict
accordance with ASME Section IX.
Casing protects the spring from damage and weather conditions. Standard Finish: Painted with semi-gloss primer.
Corrosion Resistant:
Anvil offers corrosion-resistant and weather-resistant Variable Spring Hangers to ll vital needs in the chemical and renery industries as well as in modern outdoor power plant construction. For protection against severe weather conditions or moderate corrosive conditions, the parts of the hanger are galvanized per ASTM A-153, except the spring which has a protective coating and the load column for Type F which is electro-galvanized.
Size Range: The Anvil Variable Spring Hanger in ve series and seven types is offered in twenty-three sizes (Fig. B-268 only is offered in twentyve sizes). The hanger can be furnished to take loads 10 lbs. to 50,000 lbs. Ordering:
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) (11) Size Type Figure number Product name Desired supporting force in operating position Calculated amount and direction of pipe movement from installed to operating position. Customers identication number (if any) When ordering Type F spring specify if roller or guided, load column is to be furnished. When ordering Type G, specify total load and load per spring plus center to center rod dimensions. If required, specify with travel stop When ordering corrosion resistant, specify C-268, C-82, C-98, Triple-CR, or Quadruple-CR completely galvanized except coated spring coil.
Advantages of a Protective Coating: Protects from a wide range of corrosives. Does not affect the ex life of the spring. Recommended for ambient temperatures up to 200 F Travel stop:
The functional design of the pre-compressed variable spring hanger permits the incorporation of a two-piece travel stop that locks the hanger spring against upward or downward movement for temporary conditions of underload or overload. The complete travel stop, the up travel stop only for cold set purposes or the down travel stop only which may be employed during erection, hydrostatic test (Anvil permits a hydrostatic test load of 2 times the normal operating load for the spring hanger) or chemical cleanout will be furnished only when specied. The travel stop is painted red UP TRAVEL STOP and is installed at the v factory with a caution tag INDICATOR METAL (Load is read from attached calling attention STRAPS bottom of indicator) that the device must be removed before the pipe DOWN TRAVEL v line is put in service. STOP CAUTION Permanently attached TAG travel stops available upon request.
v v v
N IO UT CA
Hole
LIFTING LUGS
PH 132
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Consideration should be given to the seven standard types offered (see illustration on the below). Special variable spring hangers can be fabricated for unusual conditions.
Type A
Type B
Type C
Type D
Recommended Service: Pipe hangers located at points that are subject to vertical thermal movement and for which a constant support hanger is not required (see recommended service for constant support hanger, page PH-151). Type D & E spring hangers may accommodate less than 4 of rod swing depending on size, gure number, and application. Installation: Securely attach hanger to the building. Attach lower hanger rod and turn the load coupling until the load indicator is positioned at the desired setting indicated on the load scale plate.
How to Determine Series: Complete sizing information is given on the hanger selection chart on page PH-134 - PH-135. The sizing information is applicable to hangers of all series. As noted on the hanger selection charts that the total spring deection in the casing leaves a reserve (overtravel) above and below the recommended working load range.
PH 133
Spring Hangers
Fig. 82, Fig. B-268, Fig. 98, Triple Spring, and Quadruple Spring (cont.) Fig. C-82, Fig. C-268, Fig. C-98, Triple-CR, and Quadruple-CR Spring (Corrosion Resistant)
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Spring Hanger Size and Series Selection
How to use hanger selection table:
In order to choose a proper size hanger, it is necessary to know the actual load which the spring is to support and the amount and direction of the pipe line movement from the cold to the hot position. Find the actual load of the pipe in the load table. As it is desirable to support the actual weight of the pipe when the line is hot, the actual load is the hot load. To determine the cold load, read the spring scale, up or down, for the amount of expected movement. The chart must be read opposite from the direction of the pipes movement. The load arrived at is the cold load. If the cold load falls outside of the working load range of the hanger selected, relocate the actual or hot load in the adjacent column and nd the cold load. When the hot and cold loads are both within the working range of a hanger, the size number of that hanger will be found at the top of the column.
Load Table (lbs) for Selection of Hanger Size (sizes 10 through 22 on next page) Working Range (in) Shaded Rows Show Overtravel Figure No. Quad. Triple 98 B-268 82 B-268 Only 000
7 7 8 9 10 11 12 12
Hanger size Fig. 82, Fig. B-268, Fig. 98, Triple & Quadruple Spring 0
43 44 46 48 50 52 54 56 58 59 61 63 65 67 69 71 73 74 76 78 80 82 84 86 88 89 91 93 95
00
19 20 22 24 26 28 30 31 34 35 38 40 41 43 45 47 49 50 53 55 56 58 60 62 64 66 68 70 72
1
63 66 68 71 74 76 79 81 84 87 89 92 95 97 100 102 105 108 110 113 116 118 121 123 126 129 131 134 137
2
81 84 88 91 95 98 101 105 108 111 115 118 122 125 128 132 135 138 142 145 149 152 155 159 162 165 169 172 176
3
105 109 114 118 123 127 131 136 140 144 149 153 158 162 166 171 175 179 184 188 193 197 201 206 210 214 219 223 228
4
141 147 153 159 165 170 176 182 188 194 200 206 212 217 223 229 235 241 247 253 258 264 270 276 282 288 294 300 306
5
189 197 206 213 221 228 236 244 252 260 268 276 284 291 299 307 315 323 331 339 347 354 362 370 378 386 394 402 410
6
252 263 273 284 294 305 315 326 336 347 357 368 378 389 399 410 420 431 441 452 462 473 483 494 504 515 525 536 546
7
336 350 364 378 392 406 420 434 448 462 476 490 504 518 532 546 560 574 588 602 616 630 644 658 672 686 700 714 728
8
450 469 488 506 525 544 563 581 600 619 638 656 675 694 713 731 750 769 788 806 825 844 863 881 900 919 938 956 975
9
600 625 650 675 700 725 750 775 800 825 850 875 900 925 950 975 1,000 1,025 1,050 1,075 1,100 1,125 1,150 1,175 1,200 1,225 1,250 1,275 1,300
112
1 2
1 4
11 2
12
14
14 14 15 16
1 2
17 18 19 20
412
112
3 4
21 21 22 23
24 25 26 27
10
712
212
11 4
28 28 29 30 31
112
12
14
15
30 15 7 5 4
42 21 10 7 5
54 27 13 9 7
70 35 17 12 9
94 47 23 16 12
126 63 31 21 16
168 84 42 28 21
224 112 56 37 28
300 150 75 50 38
Note: General rule for series selection use Fig. 82 for up to 12" of movement up to 1" use Fig. B-268, up to 2" use Fig. 98, up to 3" use a Triple, up to 4" use a Quadruple. Double check to assure desired variability is achieved.
PH 134
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Load Table (lbs) for Selection of Hanger Size (Cont. from previous page) Hanger size Fig. 82, Fig. B-268, Fig. 98, Triple & Quadruple Spring 10
780 813 845 878 910 943 975 1,008 1,040 1,073 1,105 1,138 1,170 1,203 1,235 1,268 1,300 1,333 1,365 1,398 1,430 1,463 1,495 1,528 1,560 1,593 1,625 1,658 1,690
Working Range (in) Shaded Rows Show Overtravel Figure No. 20 21 22 82 B-268 98 Triple Quad 17 18
7,990 8,322 8,655 8,987 9,320 9,652 9,985
11
1,020 1,063 1,105 1,148 1,190 1,233 1,275 1,318 1,360 1,403 1,445 1,488 1,530 1,573 1,615 1,658 1,700 1,743 1,785 1,828 1,870 1,913 1,955 1,998 2,040 2,083 2,125 2,168 2,210
12
1,350 1,406 1,463 1,519 1,575 1,631 1,688 1,744 1,800 1,856 1,913 1,969 2,025 2,081 2,138 2,194 2,250 2,306 2,363 2,419 2,475 2,531 2,588 2,644 2,700 2,756 2,813 2,869 2,925
13
1,800 1,875 1,950 2,025 2,100 2,175 2,250 2,325 2,400 2,475 2,550 2,625 2,700 2,775 2,850 2,925 3,000 3,075 3,150 3,225 3,300 3,375 3,450 3,525 3,600 3,675 3,750 3,825 3,900
14
2,400 2,500 2,600 2,700 2,800 2,900 3,000 3,100 3,200 3,300 3,400 3,500 3,600 3,700 3,800 3,900 4,000 4,100 4,200 4,300 4,400 4,500 4,600 4,700 4,800 4,900 5,000 5,100 5,200
15
3,240 3,375 3,510 3,645 3,780 3,915 4,050 4,185 4,320 4,455 4,590 4,725 4,860 4,995 5,130 5,265 5,400 5,535 5,670 5,805 5,940 6,075 6,210 6,345 6,480 6,615 6,750 6,885 7,020
16
4,500 4,688 4,875 5,063 5,250 5,438 5,625 5,813 6,000 6,188 6,375 6,563 6,750 6,938 7,125 7,313 7,500 7,688 7,875 8,063 8,250 8,438 8,625 8,813 9,000 9,188 9,375 9,563 9,750
19
6,000 6,250 6,500 6,750 7,000 7,250 7,500 7,750 8,000 8,250 8,500 8,750 9,000 9,250 9,500 9,750
10,610 14,100 18,750 25,005 11,053 14,588 19,531 26,047 11,495 15,275 20,313 27,089 11,938 15,863 21,094 28,131 12,380 16,450 21,875 29,173 12,823 17,038 22,656 30,215 13,265 17,625 23,438 31,256
14 12 14 12
112
10,317 13,708 18,213 24,219 32,298 10,650 14,150 18,800 25,000 33,340 10,982 14,592 19,388 25,781 34,382 11,315 15,035 19,975 26,563 35,424 11,647 15,477 20,563 27,344 36,466 11,980 15,920 21,150 28,125 37,508 12,312 16,362 21,738 28,906 38,549 12,645 16,805 22,325 29,688 39,591 12,977 17,247 22,913 30,469 40,633
34 12
112
10,000 13,310 17,690 23,500 31,250 41,675 10,250 13,642 18,132 24,088 32,031 42,717 10,500 13,975 18,575 24,675 32,813 43,759 10,750 14,307 19,017 25,263 33,594 44,801 11,000 14,640 19,460 25,850 34,375 45,843 11,250 14,972 19,902 26,438 35,156 46,885 11,500 15,305 20,345 27,025 35,938 47,926 11,750 15,637 20,787 27,613 36,719 48,968 12,000 15,970 21,230 28,200 37,500 50,010 12,250 16,302 21,672 28,788 38,281 51,052 12,500 16,635 22,115 29,375 39,063 52,094 12,750 16,967 22,557 29,963 39,844 53,136 13,000 17,300 23,000 30,550 40,625 54,178
112
412
114
212
712
10
14
12
112
Note: General rule for series selection use Fig. 82 for up to 12" of movement up to 1" use Fig. B-268, up to 2" use Fig. 98, up to 3" use a Triple-, up to 4" use a Quadruple. Double check to assure desired variability is achieved.
PH 135
Spring Hangers
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Variable Spring Check List for Requesting a Quote or Ordering
Page ___ of ____
Anvil International Precision Park 160 Frenchtown Rd. North Kingstown, RI 02852
For technical information regarding Variable Springs Call or Fax: Fax Number: (401) 886-3056 Phone Number: (401) 886-3025
Finish: Standard Primer: ______________ Galvanized: _______________ Special Coating: __________________________________ Quantity: ______________ Figure No.: Options are: 82, B-268, 98, Triple, Quadruple
or: C-82, C-268, C-98, Triple-CR, Quadruple-CR
Size: Options are: #0 through #22 (B-268 / C-268 also available in #00 and #000) Type: Options are: A through G* Hot (Operating or Design) Load (lbs): _________ (optional)** Cold/Installed (Factory Set) Load (lbs): _________ (optional)** Vertical Movement: _________ + (up) or (down) (optional)** Mark Number: _______________________ (If Required) Travel Stops: Yes: _________ No: __________
If travel stops are ordered and hot & cold loads are not provided, then the spring will be set to mid range load.
Notes:
* Type G Springs must also include the C-to-C dimension & the load per spring. ** Anvil will determine the appropriate Figure Number and will calculate the Cold Load when only the Hot Load and movement are specied.
PH 136
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Spring Hangers (Type A)
D G ROD SIZE "A" LOAD INDICATOR
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+3 1/2" ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D SEE TABLE BELOW
Fig. B-268, Fig. C-268 Type A: Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Hanger Size
000 00 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
Weight
5 6 8 8 9 14 15 16 26 29 31 65 71 65 71 89 93 111 133 162 330 376 480 556 705
Rod Size A
1 2
Casing Length B
5 5 8 7916 61116 7916 8516
Casing Diam C
4
Flange Diam D
5 1 8
Thread Depth G
716
Z
1316
1316
3 4
1 2
5 1 8
1516
716
1 1
1516 716
1 2
71516 8 5 8 81316
5916
61516
71516 71316
1 3 8
1116 916
5 8
10 10716
6 5 8
8 3 8
9116 81516
1516
5 8
5 8 3 4
3 4
6 6 7 7 8 9 10 10 11
1218 10716 10716 1318 1314 1314 16116 1818 1814 2012 2334 27516 3338
8 5 8
1034
1138 9 7 8 9 1 2 1138 1138 1138 141316 1634 16 1838 2158 2378 2934
1 1 4
1 1 2 11116 1116
1 2 3 8 3 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3
8 5 8
1034
1 1 4 1 1 4 11516
1 1 1 4 1 1 4 1 3 8 1 3 8 2 1 4 2 3 4 3
1034 8 5 8 1138
1234
1578
2 3 4
21116 31116 3 3 4
1234
1678
3 5 8
PH 137
Spring Hangers
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Fig. B-268, C-268
D
S
R T
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
R
H
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
LOAD INDICATOR B
LOAD INDICATOR
B
ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D. SEE TABLE BELOW
ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D. SEE TABLE BELOW
Flange Diam D 5 1 8
R 1 1 4
Z
1316
1116
1 1 2
1 2
1116
5 1 8
1516
1 1 2
7 9 1 2 8 8 7 8 9 7 8 9 1 2 9 7 8 91516
1316
3 4
1 1 4
7 8
1 4
1 2
1116
5916
61516
1516
1 1 2
1 1 4
7 8
1 4
1 1 1 3 8 1116 916
5 8 3 4
5 8
1316
10 10716 1218 10716 10716 1318 1314 1314 16116 1818 1814 2012 2334 27516 3338
6 5 8
8 3 8
1516
1 1 2
11316 11716 1378 1238 1212 1438 1538 1538 19316 2118 2218 25 2814 3118 3734
1 1 4
1116
1 4
3 4
6 6 7 7 8 9 10 10 11
1516
8 5 8
1034
1 1 4
1 1 2
1 1 4
1 1 4
3 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3
1 1 4 1 1 2 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 3 8 2 5 8 2 7 8 3 1 8 3 3 8
8 5 8
1034 1034
1 1 4
2 3
1 1 2 2 2 2 1 2 3 4 4
1 5 8 2 2 2 3 8 2 5 8 2 7 8 3 1 8 3 3 8 3 5 8 3 7 8
1 2 5 8 5 8 3 4
8 5 8
1138
11516
3 4
1234
1578
2 3 4
3 4
4 1 2 4 1 2 5
1 1
1234
1678
3 5 8
PH 138
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Spring Hangers (Type D & Type E)
MUST BE PINNED OR TACKED BY CUSTOMER
ROD SIZE "A" ROD, NUTS & WASHER NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D. SEE TABLE BELOW
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
ROD SIZE "A" ROD AND NUT NOT FURNISHED LENGTH TO SUIT CUSTOMER
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
LOAD INDICATOR B
LOAD INDICATOR
B
3 1/2"
Type D permits adjustment of the hanger from the top. This type has
a piece of tubing which passes through a hole in the top cap. Type D is especially adapted for use where the hanger is set above the supporting beams and pipe is suspended below.
Type E is designed to permit adjustment from either above or below the hanger, when it is installed upon the supporting member and pipe is suspended below. A coupling tapped right hand both ends is furnished.
1 2
Casing Diam C 4
Flange Diam D 5 1 8
Height of Spacer M 3 1 8
5 1 8
1516
1 1 4
3 1 8
1 2
5916
61516
1516
1 1 4
3 1 8
5 8
10 10716 1218 10716 10716 1318 1318 151516 18 1814 2012 2334 27516 3338
6 5 8
8 3 8
1516
1 1 2
3 4
6 6 7 7 8 9 10 11
8 5 8
1034
1 1 4
1 3 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3
8 5 8
1034 1034
1 1 4 1 1 4 11516
2 1 4 3 3 3 1 2 4 4916 5 5916 6 1 4 6 5 8
8 5 8
1138
1234
1578
2 3 4
1234
1678
3 5 8
Rod Length Y 10 1134 11116 111516 121116 111116 12516 13 13516 1414 1434 1558 1678 141116 151316 1838 1914 1934 22916 2518 251116 2838 32316 35916 42
Rod Take-out Q 6
PH 139
Spring Hangers
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Fig. B-268, C-268
D
S
412 512 634 634 634 634 634 634 7 10 10 13 12
2 - 312 4-6 8 - 10 8 - 10
Cast Iron Cast Iron Cast Iron Steel Cast Iron Steel Cast Iron Steel Cast Iron Steel Cast Iron Steel Cast Iron Steel
780 1,900 4,200 14,000 6,150 26,000 9,960 34,000 12,200 60,000 15,000 60,000 24,000 60,000
134 218 234 234 312 312 334 334 4 4 412 5 41516 5
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
12 - 14
12 - 14 16 - 20 16 - 20 24 24 30 30 36 36
v P v v
1612 814
Type F is for use under a base elbow or piping that must be supported
directly from the oor. If more than 14" of horizontal translation occurs of loads resting on the at load ange or other at surface junction between the type F spring hanger and the load, a double roller design pipe roll is recommended. Pipe rolls, as illustrated above, will be furnished on request. For dimension of the pipe roll, refer to Fig. 271, see page PH-118. Base type variable springs will be furnished with an extended load column
on special order. Guided Load Columns available on request, furnished standard with rolls. Adjustment to the required load rating is made by inserting a bar into holes provided in the load column and turning the column. The 2" increment between minimum and maximum X dimensions is the amount of eld adjustment available and is in excess of the amount required for load adjustment.
Lengths - X* Min 7316 9 1 8 8 1 4 9 1 8 9 7 8 9916 1014 1012 111116 1218 131316 1218 1218 141316 141316 171516 20 20516 22916 251316 29716 3512 Max 9316 1118 1014 1118 1178 11916 1214 1212 131116 1418 151316 1418 1418 161316 161316 191516 22 22516 24916 271316 31716 3712
Load Thickness Load Flange of Load Col. Diam Diam Flange 1.9 3 7 8
316
5 1 8
7 1 2
8 3 4
5 8
1 4
1.9
3 7 8
316
5916
61516
7 1 2
7 3 4
8 3 4
3 4
14
2.875
5 3 8
316
3.5
6 3 8
1 4
8 5 8
1034
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
4.5
8 3 8
1 2
8 5 8
1034 1034
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
8 3 8
1 2
8 5 8
1138
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
8 3 8
1 2
1234
1578
1714
1534
22
3 4
5 8
2.5
1212
1 2
1234
1678
1714
1678
22
3 4
5 8
3.0
1212
1 2
*Hanger take-out or installed height. With pipe movement up, cold to hot, installed height should be the mid-point between the minimum and maximum "X" dimension, plus thickness of load flange. With pipe movement down, cold to hot installed height should be mid-point between the minimum and maximum "X" dimension, plus the amount of vertical movement and load flange thickness. Note: Sizes 16" and larger are furnished with a hexagon nut at the top of a solid load column to facilitate adjustment with a wrench.
PH 140
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Spring Hangers (Type G)
C-C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED ROD SIZE "A" ROD NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. TH'D SEE TABLE BELOW MIN = Z MAX = Z + 3 1/2" F
P W
N
FIG. B-268 SIZE TYPE G MARKNO. SPG.RATE LB./IN. 2 1/2 2 1/4 2 1 3/4 1 1/2 1 1/4 1 3/4 1/2 1/4 0 DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.)
LOAD INDICATOR
Weight
Casing Dia. C 4
Flange Dia. D 5 1 8
Max C-C
24 26 30 31 32 41 42 43 63 69 73 143 157 145 157 195 203 250 298 354 690 783 993 1,197 1,496
24
1 1 2
1316
1316
3 4
1 2
5 1 8
1516
C3 x 4.1
24
5 8
1 1 2
1 1 C3 x 4.1 30
3 4
1 2
71516 8 5 8 81316
5916
61516
1516
2716 1 3 4 1 5 8
1 3 8
1116 916
5 8
10 10716
6 5 8
8 3 8
1516
11116 2 1 2
C3 x 4.1
36
5 8 3 4
3 4
6 6 7 7 8 9 10 10 11
1218 10716 10716 1318 1314 1314 16116 1818 1814 2012 2334 27516 3338
8 5 8
1034
1 1 4
3 1 4 3716 31316
C4 x 5.4
36
1 1 4
1 1 2 11116 1116
1 1 1 4 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3
8 5 8
1034 1034
1 1 4
3 1 4 3 1 8 31516
36 33
1 1 2 1 1 2
1 2 3 8 3 8
8 5 8
1138
11516
4 1 8 4 4
36
2 1 8 2 3 8 2 5 8 2 7 8 3 1 8 3 3 8
1234
1578
2 3 4
4 1 8 4516 4 3 8
C12 x 20.7
42 40
21116 31116 3 3 4
1234
1678
3 5 8
C15 x 33.9
48
PH 141
Spring Hangers
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Fig. 82, C-82
D D G "A" LOAD SCALE & NAME PLATE
R H
LOAD INDICATOR T
0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4
J B
LOAD INDICATOR B
F "A"
C
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+134"
F "A" C
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+134"
F
"A"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+134"
FIG. 82 TYPE A
K "A" LOAD INDICATOR LOAD SCALE & NAME PLATE D
FIG. 82 TYPE B
D LOAD INDICATOR FIELD PINNED OR TACKED ROD SIZE "A"
FIG. 82 TYPE C
LOAD COLUMN
0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -82 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
D LOAD INDICATOR B
0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -82 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
C 1 3 4 "
C E'
FOUR SLOTS
FIG. 82 TYPE D
"A"
FIG. 82 TYPE E
C - C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED MIN = Z MAX = Z + 134" P W F N
0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4
DEFL. (IN.) LOAD (LB.) SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -82 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
FIG. 82 TYPE F
C
The Anvil variable short spring hanger, Fig. 82, embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed to the same exacting specications. This is useful in conned areas where thermal movement of the piping is relatively small. The minimum and maximum loads for the individual sizes of the Fig. 82 are exactly the same as those for the Fig. B-268. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing this hanger are found on page PH-133 through PH-135.
LOAD INDICATOR
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Short Spring
Casing
Z
1516
Pin Hgh H
112
Types B, C Type D Hgt Nut Rod Clevis Thk. Length Allow. Spacer R Opening T M K Y S
712 114
78 14
4516 4116 5116 4716 5116 5116 6316 51516 618 738 6316 6316 738 738 738 9516 10916 101116 1134 14 1358 1758
518
1516
1116
614 6 7 638 7 7316 8516 8116 858 978 81116 81116 1038 1138 1138 131116 141516 161316 1838 2058 2078 2538
1 218
34 716 1116
114
134
1116
916
118
58
5916
61516
1516
1316 1116
1316
218
716
1116
112
114
78
14
114
134
61116 714
658
838
1516
1116
1316
218
58
1316
112
114
1116
14
112
134
814 714 714 834 878 878 1058 1178 13 14 1618 18 2214
1516
112
114
114
38
1134 10716 1114 1258 1358 1418 1578 1758 19316 2058 23516 25 2958
134
134
858
1034 1034
1
34 34
2 2 6
1 1 138
2 3 3 4 412 412 5
112 2 2 212 3 4 4
12 58 58 34
134
858
1138
2 212
134
1234
1578
234
2916 21116
1 118
38
214 234 3
34
134
1 1
1234
1678
358
234
238
114
Weight P A,B,C
3 4
Thick
1 4
Length X Min
6516 61516
Thick.
316
Max
61316 7716 7 3 8 7 1 2 8 8 7 8 91516 101516 91516 91516 11716 11916 11916 1358 1478 16116 17116 19316 2118 2538
Type D,E
5 6 7 10 11 12 193 22 23 52 58 51 53 63 55 79 91
F
11 11 12 10 20 21 33 35 36 78 84 76 78 81 91 100 112
G*
27 29 33 35 36 51 57 59 125 137 121 132 154 159 198 230 266
6 7 8 11 12 13 20
7 1 2
7 3 4
8 3 4
3 4
1 4
2.875
5 3 4
316
6 7 8 7 7 1 2
C3 x 4.1
30
3 4
3 4
1078
3 4
3 8
3.50
6 3 8
1 4
8 3 8 81516
C3 x 4.1
36
3 4
23 24 56 62 55 58
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
4.50
8 3 8
1 2
C4 x 5.4
36
1 1 4
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
4.50 4.50
8 3 8
1 2
36 33
1 1 2 1 1 2
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
2.00
8 3 8
1 2
36
2 1 8
105 126 226 270 246 275 302 344 339 348 431 443
1714
1534
22
3 4
5 8
2.50
1212
1 2
1714
1534
22
3 4
5 8
3.00
1212
1 2
take-out or installed height. With pipe movement up, cold to hot, installed height should be the mid point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus thickness of load ange. With pipe movement down, cold to hot installed height should be mid-point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus the amount of vertical movement and load ange thickness. (Type F only). *Weight based on 24" center-to-center dimension. See page PH-140 for Type F roller information.
PH 143
Spring Hangers
Fig. 82, C-82 Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in) Rod Take Out By Type Type A A B,C E G Thread Lug Depth Hole E J Q N Size G
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Fig. 98, C-98
D ROD SIZE "A" G D
Double Spring
D T S
R T H ROD SIZE "A" K D
R
H M
DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2
LOAD INDICATOR
2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
J B
3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO.
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+7"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+7"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+7" C
FIG. 98 TYPE A
D
FIG. 98 TYPE B
LOAD FLANGE LOAD COLUMN
FIG. 98 TYPE C
FIG. 98 TYPE D
DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO. DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 SPG.RATE LB./IN. FIG. -98 SIZE TYPE MARKNO. DEFL.(IN.) LOAD (LB.) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 11/4 11/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 23/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2
P W
FOUR SLOTS C
LOAD INDICATOR
F MUST BE PINNED BY CUSTOMER R.H. TH'DS. F ROD SIZE "A" 7" COUPLING POSITION AT MAXIMUM LOAD
C E
*ROD, NUTS & WASHERS NOT FURNISHED LENGTH OF R.H. THD (SEE TDIM. TABLE)
FIG. 98 TYPE F
Q
FIG. 98 TYPE G
The Anvil Variable Double Spring Hanger, Fig. 98, embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed to the same exacting specications. Each basic unit consists of two springs arranged in series within a single casing. A centering guide is provided to assure the permanent alignment of the spring assembly. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing this hanger may be found on page PH-133 through PH-135.
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Double Spring
Casing
Flange Dia. D
Z
1516
Type A Types B, C Clevis Thread Lug Pin Opening Depth Hole Hgt R S Size H G
716 1116
Hgt Spacer M
5 1 2
1258 9 1438 1578 14 9 1514 1658 161116 9 1858 19916 9 10 10 20316 2258 1814 1912 2434 2478 2478 2978 34 3314 3734 4414 4978 62 1234 1678 3 5 8 1234 1578 2 3 4 85 8 1034 1138 11516 85 8 1034 1 1 4 85 8 1034 1 1 4 65 8 8 3 8
1516
12316 131516 15316 13716 15316 151516 151516 18316 181116 1878 2138 1678 1778 2314 2318 2318 28916 321316 3118 3512 4218 45716 5818
1418 1578 1718 1538 1718 1778 18116 20516 201316 2138 2378 1938 2078 2614 2718 2718 321516 37316 37316 4218 4834 521116 6618 7 7 12 7 12 9 12 9 9 9
5 1 8
11 2
1 1 4
7 8
5916
61516
1516
1316
1116 1316
11 2
1 1 4
7 8
1 4
1 1 4
5 1 2
1 1 8
1116 1516
11 2
1 1 4
1116
1 4
1 1 2
5 1 2
1
7 8 5 8 3 4 1 2 1 2
1516
11 2
1 1 4
1 1 4
3 8
2978 2512 2714 3238 3338 3334 3878 4312 43316 4818 55316 6058 7318
1 3 4
5 1 2
2 1 4 3 3 3 1 2 4 4916 5 5916 6 1 4 6 5 8
5 1 2
5 1 2
5 1 2
1 1
5 1 2
Weight P A,B,C
12 1 1 2 14 16 22 25 27 41 49 61 97
Thick
1 4
Length X s Min
14316 151516 17716 1558
Thick.
316
Max
16316 171516 19716 1758 1878 2014 2038 22516 2314 2378 26516 211516 23316 28716 28916 28916 3378 38 37516 411316 48516 5378 66
Max C-C
Type D,E
12 14 16 21 24 26 40 48 52 94 108 95 104 139 147 163 202 247 477 548 723 845
F
20 21 23 35 39 41 62 72 75 136 150 134 144 181 188 201 241 287 550 624 807 872
G*
37 41 45 55 61 65 93 109 133 207 241 209 223 305 323 368 462 572 1,056 1,231 1,633 1,965
24
7 1 2
73 4
8 3 4
3 4
1 4
2.88
5 3 4
316
C3 x 4.1
30
3 4
1078
3 4
3 8
3.50
6 3 8
1 4
C3 x 4.1
36
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
4.50
8 3 8
1 2
C4 x 5.4
36
1 1 4
114 96 108
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
4.50 4.50
8 3 8
1 2
36 33
1 1 2 1 1 2
1314
10916
1612
3 4
1 2
2.00
8 3 8
1 2
36
2 1 8
1714
1534
22
3 4
5 8
2.50
1212
1 2
C12 x 20.7
42 40
2 3 8 3 1 8 3 3 8
3.00
1212
1 2
C15 x 33.9
48
s Hanger take-out or installed height. With pipe movement up, cold to hot, installed height should be the mid point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus thickness of load flange. With pipe movement down, cold to hot installed height should be mid-point between the minimum and maximum X dimension, plus the amount of vertical movement and load flange thickness. (Type F only). *Weight based on 24" center-to-center dimension. See page PH-140 for type F roller information.
PH 145
Spring Hangers
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Triple Spring, Triple Spring-CR
D ROD SIZE* "A" G M
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
D S LOAD INDICATOR R T H
T R H
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD INDICATOR
TRIPLE TYPE A
LOAD INDICATOR D MUST BE PINNED OR TACKED BY CUSTOMER
TRIPLE TYPE B
D LOAD FLANGE
TRIPLE TYPE C
TRIPLE TYPE D
C-C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED NOT TO EXCEED C-C MAX
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
LOAD INDICATOR
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
N B
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
TRIPLE TYPE F
TRIPLE TYPE G
The Anvil Variable Triple Spring Hanger, embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed to the same exacting specications. Each basic unit consists of three springs arranged in series within a single casing. A centering guide is provided to assure the permanent alignment of the spring assembly. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing this hanger may be found on page PH-133 through PH-135.
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Rod Take Out For Types A Z E 1918 J 2058 2314 2512 221116 24916 2658 2612 29716 301316 31116 3434 28316 30916 3814 Y 2818 3034 33 30316 32116 3418 34316 3718 3812 3878 42916 36 3838 46116 1112 3 7 8 1112 3 1118 2 1118 2 1118 1 1 2 Q N B&C D E G
Type D
Type F Loaded Length Dim X Min 201516 Max 221516 25916 27916 25 2678 281516 281516 3178 3314 3358 37516 3034 3258 40516 401316 401116 4818 54516 53516
Type G
1918 12 2134 24 21316 12 23116 2518 12 13 29516 29916 13 3314 261116 28916 1 1 4 8 5 8 1 1 4 1 1 4 25 271516 6 5 8
1516 1516
1516
1516
2134 24 21316
716
1 1 4
7 3 4
23916 251316 23
1 1 2
5916
1516
1516
716
1 1 4
7 3 4
5 8
1 1 2
71116
2978 3114
1 3 4 1 2 2 1 4 1 2 1 2
3158 7916 35516 2834 3058 7916 38516 381316 381116 4618 52516 51516
1 1 4
3614
PH 147
Spring Hangers
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Quadruple Spring, Quadruple Spring-CR
D ROD SIZE* "A" LOAD INDICATOR R T H D
S D T R H M
QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/IN QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/IN QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/IN QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/ IN
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD INDICATOR
LOAD (LB)
B J
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+14"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+14"
MIN.=Z MAX.=Z+14"
C
QUADRUPLE TYPE A
D
QUADRUPLE TYPE B
D LOAD FLANGE
QUADRUPLE TYPE C
QUADRUPLE TYPE D
C-C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED NOT TO EXCEED C-C MAX ROD SIZE "A" C
QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/ IN
QUADRUPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO. SPG.RATE 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 7 3/4 8 8 1/4 8 1/2 8 3/4 9 9 1/4 9 1/2 9 3/4 10 DEFL.(IN) LB/IN
LOAD INDICATOR
N B
LOAD (LB)
B
LOAD (LB)
FOUR SLOTS
LOAD INDICATOR
DEFL.(IN) LOAD (LB) 0 1/4 1/2 3/4 1 1 1/4 1 1/2 1 3/4 2 2 1/4 2 1/2 2 3/4 3 3 1/4 3 1/2 3 3/4 4 4 1/4 4 1/2 4 3/4 5 5 1/4 5 1/2 5 3/4 6 6 1/4 6 1/2 6 3/4 7 7 1/4 7 1/2 LB IN SPG.RATE TRIPLE SPRING SIZE TYPE MARK NO.
QUADRUPLE TYPE F
QUADRUPLE TYPE G
14"
The Anvil Variable Quadruple Spring Hanger, embodies all of the Fig. B-268 features and is designed to the same exacting specications. Each basic unit consists of four springs arranged in series within a single casing. A centering guide is provided to assure the permanent alignment of the spring assembly. This hanger is offered in the seven basic types as shown here. The load table and instructions for sizing this hanger may be found on page PH-133 through PH-135.
Return to TOC
SPRING HANGERS
Rod Take Out for Types Min Thd F A Z E 2518 J 2658 3018 3318 2938 3178 3458 34716 3838 40316 40516 4514 3612 3912 4934 5114 51 Y 3718 4058 4358 3978 4238 4518 4518 49116 5078 5118 1518 2 1518 2 1518 1 1 2 Q N B&C D E G
Type D
Type F Loaded Length Dim X Min 261516 Max 281516 32716 35716 311116 34316 361516 3678 401316 4258 4278 471316 39116 41916 511316 52716 52316
Type G
Casing Dia C
16
1516
1516
716
1 1 4
7 3 4
1 1 2
16
5916
1516
1516
716
1 1 4
7 3 4
16
6 5 8
1516
1516
5 8
1 1 2
7916
1 3 4 8 5 8 1 1 4 1 1 4 4334 35 3712 1 1 4 1 1 4 4734 4838 4818 60916 611516 611516 1512 1512 4 3 56116 47516 50516 3 7 8 1 2 1 2 50716 50316 7116 491316 1512 3 1 2 2 1 4 7116 451316 37116 39916 3 35 3712
17
PH 149
Spring Hangers
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
The exclusive geometric design of Anvil Model R Constant Support Hanger assures perfectly constant support through the entire deection of the pipe load. This counter-balancing of the load and spring moments about the main pivot is obtained by the use of carefully designed compression type load springs, lever, and spring tension rods. As the lever moves from the high to the low position, the load spring is compressed and the resulting increasing force acting on the decreasing spring moment arm creates a turning moment about the main pivot which is exactly equal and opposite to the turning moment of the load and load moment arm. As the lever moves from the low to the high position, the load spring is increasing in length and the resulting decreasing force acting on the increasing spring moment arm creates a turning moment about the main pivot which is exactly equal and opposite to the turning moment of the load and load moment arm.
Fixed Load Spring Spring Pivot
K Rod Frame
v v
Load Scale
v
v
H
M
v v v
v v
v
VERTICAL v
9.921
A
v
v
VERTICAL v
v
B P A
v
L
W SIN
W SIN
HIGH POSITION
MIDDLE POSITION
LOW POSITION
(1)
sin sin --------- = -------- Y sin sin --------- = --------Z Y sin = Y sin -----------Z
sin = X sin = X Z
The spring force F is equal to the spring constant K times the spring deection E; thus: (6) F = KE; Therefore equation (5) may be written as: YZ sin (7) Spring Moment = KE ---------------
X sin Substituting in (1), we have (2) ---- = --------- and (3) X = YZ sin -------------- YZ The load L is suspended from the lever at point A and at any point within the load travel range the moment of the load about the main lever-pivot P is equal to the load times its moment arm, thus: (4) Load moment = L (Wsin), where (Wsin) is the load moment arm The spring is attached at one of its ends to the xed pivot B. The springs free end is attached by means of a rod to the lever-pivot D. This spring arrangement provides a spring moment about the main lever-pivot P which opposes the load moment and is equal to the spring force F times its moment arm; thus: YZ sin (5) Spring Moment = F --------------- , YZ sin where --------------- is the spring moment arm
To obtain perfect constant support the load moment must always equal the spring moment. Therefore: KEYZ sin (8) LW = --------------------- By proper design "" and "" are made equal. Therefore, equation (8) may be written as: (9) KEYZ LW = ---------- -
The spring and the rod are so arranged that the spring deection E always equals the distance between pivots B and D. Therefore, equation (9) may be written as: (10) LW = KYZ or, (11) L = (KYZ)/W Since equation (11) holds true for all positions of the load within its travel range and K, Y, Z, and W remain constant it is therefore true that perfect constant support is obtained.
PH 150
v
v
D W X L Y HORIZONTAL Z P
vv
Load Pivot
L
Load Yoke
Load Coupling
F
X
v
B Z
D Y HORIZONTAL
W
A
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Constant Support
Model R Fig. 80-V, C-80-V Vertical Model R Fig. 81-H, C-81-H Horizontal
Recommended Service: When piping stress is critical and pipe is subject to vertical movement in excess of 1 2 " due to thermal expansion, and also at locations where it is necessary to avoid any transfer of stress from support or onto critical terminals or connecting equipment. Approvals: WW-H-171E (Types 52, 58 and 59) and
MSS-SP-69 (Types 54, 55 and 56).
Increased load and travel capacity. Each hanger is individually calibrated before shipment to
support the exact load specied.
How to determine design: After the hanger size and design are determined, the type of constant support to be used depends upon the physical installation required by the suspension problem, i.e., whether the hanger is to be installed above, between or below steel members (see line cuts referring to Types A, B, C, etc.). It will be noted that the Type F is made in horizontal design only and the type G is made in the vertical design only. Special constant support hangers can be fabricated for unusual conditions. J-rod and K-hole diameter: Tapping or drilling for standard rod size will be furnished as shown in the J-rod and K-hole selection charts unless otherwise specied. Upper attachments, turnbuckles and clamps should be tapped to agree with the rod as shown in the selection chart. Standard rod diameters are based on the load to be carried by the upper rod which includes the weight of the hanger assembly as well as the pipe line. Tapped connections for hanger rod sizes 3" and smaller are UNC-Thread Series, Class 2 t. 31 4 " and large rod tappings are 8UN Series Threads.
PH 151
Covered spring provides protection and good appearance. J-rod swings at least 4 from vertical. Non-resonant to all vertical vibrations.
Constant Supports
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
Ordering: Specify:
(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7) (8) (9) (10) Hanger size number Figure number Type Name of hanger Loads to be supported (pounds) Total travel (inches) Actual travel (inches) Direction of movement cold to hot Customers hanger mark. When ordering Type G, specify C-C rod dimension as well as load per spring and total load. (11) For Types A, B, C, Fig. 81-H when required specify for single rod suspension. (12) Constant Support Hangers are also available corrosion-resistant as gures C-80-V and C-81-H. (Continued)
Installation:
(1) Securely attach the hanger to the building structure at a point where the load coupling is directly over the desired point of attachment to the pipe in the operating position. (1) Make certain that the moving parts of the hanger will be unobstructed. (2) Attach the lower J-rod between the pipe attachment and the load coupling. Make certain that the lower J-rod has enough thread engagement before taking up the load. A sight hole is provided for this. (3) Turn the load coupling, as you would a turnbuckle, until the travel indicator rotates to the desired cold setting (white button) marked C indicated on the position scale. If the constant support incorporates a travel stop see below. (4) After the line is in operation, check hanger for indicated hot setting. If necessary, make adjustment by turning the load coupling to bring the indicator to the hot position (red button) marked H. No other adjustment is normally required since the load as calibrated at the factory is equal to the load specied to be supported.
Load adjustment scale shown applies to size 1 through 83 only. The load adjustment scale for sizes 84 through 110 1 division equals 1%
Adjustment: When the hanger is installed, its supporting force should be in balance with the portion of the piping weight assigned to it. Each hanger is individually calibrated before shipment to support the exact load specied. All model R Constant Supports have a wide range of load adjustability. Special instructions for eld recalibration of individual hangers may be obtained from Anvil representatives. No less than 10% adjustability is provided either side of the calibrated load for plus or minus eld load adjustment. The percentage increase or decrease from the factory calibrated load should be carefully calculated. The calibrated load setting of each hanger is indicated by a die-stamp on the load adjustment scale. Load adjustments should be made from this reference point, with each division on the patented scale equal to 2% except sizes 84-110 where each division is valued at 1%. The load adjustment is made by turning the single load adjustment bolt. For example, a calibrated load of 3,000 pounds revised to 2,7600 pounds is a decrease of 240 pounds. 240/3,000 = 8%. By turning the load adjusting bolt the arrow moves in the "Decrease" direction four divisions. Note: Field Recalibration of load does not decrease total travel.
Note: See installation procedures PE-217-80 for a travel stop description on sizes 1-18.
PH 152
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
(Continued)
Model R
Model R lifting lugs:
To help alleviate the problem of lifting large size Constant Supports into position for installation, this product is available with lifting lugs (if requested) on sizes ten and larger.
3"
HM
L
Type A
Type D
Type E
Type G
Type A
Type D
Type E
Type F
PH 153
Constant Supports
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Hanger Size No.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
2
108 130 153 175 210 245 280 338 395 450 545 638 733 883 1,030 1,180 1,420 1,663 1,905 2,025 2,145 2,335 2,525 2,710 2,910 3,110 3,310 3,630 3,950 4,270 4,535 4,795 5,060 5,295 5,525
2 1 2
86 104 122 140 168 196 224 270 316 360 436 510 586 706 824 944 1,136 1,330 1,524 1,620 1,716 1,868 2,020 2,168 2,328 2,488 2,648 2,904 3,160 3,416 3,628 3,836 4,048 4,236 4,420 4,696 4,968 5,240 5,616 5,988 6,360 6,976 7,588 8,200 8,724 9,284 9,760 10,376 10,988 11,600
3
72 87 102 117 140 163 187 225 263 300 363 425 489 589 687 787 947 1,109 1,270 1,350 1,430 1,557 1,683 1,807 1,940 2,073 2,207 2,420 2,633 2,847 3,023 3,197 3,373 3,530 3,683 3,913 4,140 4,367 4,680 4,990 5,300 5,813 6,323 6,833 7,270 7,737 8,133 8,647 9,157 9,667 10,367 11,067 11,847 12,623 13,400 14,713 16,023 17,333 18,423 19,510 20,600 21,890 23,176 24,463
3 1 2
62 74 87 100 120 140 160 193 226 257 311 365 419 505 589 674 811 950 1,089 1,157 1,226 1,334 1,443 1,549 1,663 1,777 1,891 2,074 2,257 2,440 2,591 2,740 2,891 3,026 3,157 3,354 3,549 3,743 4,011 4,277 4,543 4,983 5,420 5,857 6,231 6,631 6,971 7,411 7,848 8,286 8,886 9,486 10,154 10,820 11,486 12,611 13,734 14,857 15,791 16,723 17,657 18,763 19,665 20,968
4
54 65 77 88 105 123 140 169 198 225 273 319 367 442 515 590 710 832 953 1,013 1,073 1,168 1,263 1,355 1,455 1,555 1,655 1,815 1,975 2,135 2,268 2,398 2,530 2,648 2,763 2,935 3,105 3,275 3,510 3,743 3,975 4,360 4,743 5,125 5,453 5,803 6,100 6,485 6,868 7,250 7,775 8,300 8,885 9,468 10,050 11,035 12,018 13,000 13,818 14,633 15,450 16,418 17,383 18,348
4 1 2
48 58 68 78 93 109 124 150 176 200 242 284 326 392 458 524 631 739 847 900 953 1,038 1,122 1,204 1,293 1,382 1,471 1,613 1,756 1,898 2,016 2,131 2,249 2,353 2,456 2,609 2,760 2,911 3,120 3,327 3,533 3,876 4,216 4,556 4,847 5,158 5,422 5,764 6,104 6,444 6,911 7,378 7,898 8,415 8,933 9,809 10,682 11,555 12,282 13,007 13,733 14,593 15,451 16,309
5
43 52 61 70 84 98 112 135 158 180 218 255 293 353 412 472 568 665 762 810 858 934 1,010 1,080 1,164 1,244 1,324 1,452 1,580 1,708 1,814 1,918 2,024 2,118 2,210 2,348 2,484 2,620 2,808 2,994 3,180 3,488 3,794 4,100 4,362 4,642 4,880 5,188 5,494 5,800 6,220 6,640 7,108 7,574 8,040 8,828 9,614 10,400 11,054 11,706 12,360 13,134 13,906 14,678
5 1 2
39 47 56 64 76 89 102 123 144 164 198 232 267 321 375 429 516 605 693 736 780 849 918 985 1,058 1,131 1,204 1,320 1,436 1,553 1,649 1,744 1,840 1,925 2,009 2,135 2,258 2,382 2,553 2,722 2,891 3,171 3,449 3,727 3,965 4,220 4,436 4,716 4,995 5,273 5,655 6,036 6,462 6,886 7,309 8,026 8,740 9,455 10,049 10,642 11,236 11,940 12,642 13,344
6
36 43 51 58 70 82 93 113 132 150 182 213 244 294 343 393 473 554 635 675 715 778 842 903 970 1,037 1,103 1,210 1,317 1,423 1,512 1,598 1,687 1,765 1,842 1,957 2,070 2,183 2,340 2,495 2,650 2,907 3,162 3,417 3,635 3,868 4,067 4,323 4,578 4,833 5,183 5,533 5,923 6,311 6,700 7,356 8,011 8,666 9,211 9,755 10,300 10,945 11,588 12,231
6 1 2
33 40 47 54 65 75 86 104 122 138 168 196 226 272 317 363 437 512 586 623 660 718 777 834 895 957 1,018 1,117 1,215 1,314 1,395 1,475 1,557 1,629 1,700 1,806 1,911 2,015 2,160 2,303 2,446 2,683 2,919 3,154 3,355 3,571 3,754 3,991 4,226 4,462 4,785 5,108 5,468 5,826 6,185 6,791 7,396 8,000 8,503 9,005 9,508 10,103 10,697 11,291
7
31 37 44 50 60 70 80 97 113 129 156 182 209 252 294 337 406 475 544 579 613 667 721 775 831 889 946 1,037 1,129 1,220 1,296 1,370 1,446 1,513 1,579 1,677 1,774 1,871 2,006 2,139 2,271 2,491 2,710 2,929 3,116 3,316 3,486 3,706 3,924 4,143 4,443 4,743 5,077 5,410 5,743 6,306 6,867 7,429 7,896 8,362 8,829 9,382 9,933 10,84
7 1 2
29 35 41 47 56 65 75 90 105 120 145 170 195 235 275 315 379 443 508 540 572 623 673 723 776 829 883 968 1,053 1,139 1,209 1,279 1,349 1,412 1,473 1,565 1,656 1,747 1,872 1,996 2,120 2,325 2,529 2,733 2,908 3,095 3,253 3,459 3,663 3,867 4,147 4,427 4,739 5,049 5,360 5,885 6,409 6,933 7,369 7,804 8,240 8,756 9,270 9,785
8
27 33 38 44 53 61 70 85 99 113 136 160 183 221 258 295 355 416 476 506 536 584 631 678 728 778 828 908 988 1,068 1,134 1,199 1,265 1,324 1,381 1,468 1,553 1,638 1,755 1,871 1,988 2,180 2,371 2,563 2,726 2,901 3,050 3,243 3,434 3,625 3,888 4,150 4,443 4,734 5,025 5,518 6,009 6,500 6,809 7,316 7,725 8,209 8,691 9,174
8 1 2
448 476 505 549 594 638 685 732 779 854 929 1,005 1,067 1,128 1,191 1,246 1,300 1,381 1,461 1,541 1,652 1,761 1,871 2,052 2,232 2,412 2,566 2,731 2,871 3,052 3,232 3,412 3,659 3,906 4,181 4,455 4,730 5,193 5,655 6,118 6,503 6,886 7,271 7,726 8,180 8,634
B (avg. in.)
138
178
214
234
314
358
418
458
518
512
612
678
738
778
PH 154
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Total Travel* (in); Load (lbs) See notes on page PH-157
9 912 10 1012 11 1112 12 1212 13 1312 14 1412 15 1512 16
423 450 477 519 561 602 647 691 736 807 878 949 1,008 1,066 1,124 1,177 1,228 1,304 1,380 1,456 1,560 1,663 1,767 1,938 2,108 2,278 2,423 2,579 2,711 2,882 3,052 3,222 3,456 3,689 3,949 4,208 4,467 4,904 5,341 5,778 6,141 6,503 6,867 7,297 7,725 8,154
401 426 452 492 532 571 613 655 697 764 832 899 955 1,009 1,065 1,115 1,163 1,236 1,307 1,379 1,478 1,576 1,674 1,836 1,997 2,158 2,296 2,443 2,568 2,730 2,891 3,053 3,274 3,495 3,741 3,986 4,231 4,646 5,060 5,474 6,818 6,161 6,505 6,912 7,319 7,725
381 405 429 467 505 542 582 622 662 726 790 854 907 959 1,012 1,059 1,105 1,174 1,242 1,310 1,404 1,497 1,590 1,744 1,897 2,050 2,181 2,321 2,440 2,594 2,747 2,900 3,110 3,320 3,554 3,787 4,020 4,414 4,807 5,200 5,527 5,853 6,180 6,567 6,953 7,339 1,053 1,118 1,183 1,248 1,337 1,426 1,514 1,661 1,807 1,952 2,077 2,210 2,324 2,470 2,616 2,762 2,962 3,162 3,384 3,606 3,828 4,203 4,518 4,952 5,263 5,574 5,885 6,254 6,621 6,989 1,005 1,067 1,129 1,191 1,276 1,361 1,445 1,585 1,724 1,863 1,983 2,110 2,218 2,358 2,497 2,636 2,827 3,018 3,231 3,442 3,654 4,012 4,370 4,727 5,024 5,320 5,618 5,969 6,320 6,671 962 1,021 1,080 1,139 1,221 1,302 1,383 1,516 1,649 1,782 1,896 2,018 2,122 2,255 2,389 2,522 2,704 2,887 3,090 3,293 3,495 3,838 4,180 4,521 4,806 5,089 5,374 5,710 6,046 6,381 922 978 1,035 1,092 1,170 1,247 1,325 1,453 1,581 1,708 1,817 1,934 2,033 2,162 2,289 2,417 2,592 2,767 2,962 3,156 3,350 3,678 4,006 4,333 4,606 4,877 5,150 5,472 5,794 6,116 885 939 994 1,048 1,123 1,198 1,272 1,395 1,518 1,640 1,745 1,857 1,952 2,075 2,198 2,320 2,488 2,656 2,843 3,030 3,216 3,531 3,846 4,160 4,422 4,682 4,944 5,254 5,562 5,871 851 903 955 1,008 1,080 1,151 1,223 1,341 1,459 1,577 1,678 1,785 1,877 1,995 2,113 2,231 2,392 2,554 2,734 2,913 3,092 3,395 3,698 4,000 4,251 4,502 4,754 5,051 5,348 5,645 819 870 920 970 1,040 1,109 1,178 1,292 1,405 1,518 1,615 1,719 1,807 1,921 2,035 2,148 2,304 2,459 2,632 2,805 2,978 3,269 3,561 3,852 4,094 4,335 4,578 4,864 5,150 5,436 790 838 887 936 1,003 1,069 1,136 1,246 1,355 1,464 1,558 1,658 1,743 1,853 1,962 2,071 2,221 2,371 2,538 2,705 2,871 3,152 3,433 3,714 3,947 4,180 4,414 4,690 4,965 5,242 2,001 2,145 2,289 2,451 2,612 2,772 3,044 3,315 3,586 3,811 4,036 4,262 4,529 4,795 5,061 1,934 2,073 2,213 2,369 2,524 2,680 2,942 3,204 3,466 3,684 3,902 4,120 4,378 4,635 4,892 1,871 2,006 2,142 2,293 2,443 2,593 2,847 3,101 3,355 3,565 3,776 3,987 4,236 4,485 4,734 1,813 1,944 2,075 2,221 2,367 2,513 2,759 3,004 3,250 3,454 3,658 3,863 4,104 4,346 4,587
51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63
B (avg. in.)
814
834
914
958
1018
1058
11
1112
12
1238
1278
1338
1378
1414
1434
PH 155
Constant Supports
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Hanger Size No.
64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 100 101 102 103 104 105 106 107 108 109 110
412
17,089 17,866 19,615 21,362 23,111 24,564 26,015 27,466 29,186 30,904 32,622 34,489 36,355 38,222 40,297 42,371 44,444 46,666 48,888 51,111
5
15,380 16,080 17,654 19,226 20,800 22,108 23,414 24,720 26,268 27,814 29,360 31,040 32,720 34,400 36,268 38,134 40,000 42,000 44,000 46,000 49,200 52,400 55,400 58,400 61,400 66,000
512
13,982 14,618 16,049 17,478 18,909 20,098 21,286 22,473 23,880 25,286 26,691 28,218 29,746 31,273 32,971 34,668 36,364 38,182 40,000 41,819 44,728 47,637 50,364 53,091 55,819 60,000
6
12,816 13,400 14,711 16,021 17,333 18,423 19,511 20,599 21,889 23,177 24,466 25,866 27,266 28,666 30,222 31,779 33,332 35,000 36,665 38,332 40,998 43,665 46,165 48,665 51,165 54,998 61,331 67,164 73,500 80,830 87,500
612
11,831 12,370 13,580 14,790 16,000 17,007 18,011 19,016 20,207 21,396 22,585 23,878 25,170 26,462 27,899 29,335 30,770 32,309 33,847 35,386 37,847 40,309 42,616 44,924 47,232 50,771 56,617 62,002 67,848 74,617 81,540
7
10,986 11,486 12,610 13,733 14,857 15,792 16,725 17,657 18,763 19,868 20,972 22,172 23,372 24,572 25,906 27,239 28,572 30,000 31,429 32,858 35,144 37,429 39,572 41,715 43,858 47,144 52,572 57,573 63,001 69,287 75,716 78,930 82,145 85,360 87,500
712
10,253 10,720 11,769 12,817 13,866 14,738 15,609 16,480 17,512 18,542 19,573 20,693 21,813 22,933 24,178 25,422 26,666 27,999 29,333 30,666 32,799 34,932 36,932 38,932 40,932 43,999 49,065 53,732 58,799 64,665 70,665 73,665 76,665 79,665 82,665 85,998 87,500
8
9,613 10,050 11,034 12,016 13,000 13,818 14,632 15,450 16,418 17,384 18,350 19,400 20,450 21,500 22,668 23,834 25,000 26,250 27,500 28,750 30,750 32,750 34,625 36,500 38,375 41,250 46,000 50,375 55,125 60,625 66,250 69,063 71,875 74,688 77,500 80,625 83,750 86,875 87,500
812
9,047 9,459 10,385 11,310 12,236 13,005 13,773 14,542 15,452 16,362 17,271 18,259 19,248 20,236 21,335 22,432 23,530 24,707 25,883 27,060 28,942 30,824 32,589 34,354 36,119 38,825 43,295 47,413 51,884 57,060 62,355 65,002 67,649 70,296 72,943 75,884 78,826 81,767 84,708 87,500
9
8,544 8,933 9,808 10,681 11,555 12,282 13,008 13,733 14,593 15,452 16,311 17,244 18,178 19,111 20,149 21,185 22,222 23,333 24,444 25,555 27,333 29,111 30,777 32,444 34,111 36,666 40,888 44,777 49,000 53,888 58,888 61,388 63,888 66,388 68,888 71,666 74,444 77,221 80,000 83,610 87,221 87,500
912
8,094 8,463 9,291 10,119 10,947 11,635 12,323 13,010 13,825 14,639 15,452 16,336 17,221 18,105 19,088 20,070 21,052 22,105 23,157 24,210 25,894 27,578 29,157 30,736 32,315 34,736 38,736 42,420 46,420 51,051 55,788 58,156 60,525 62,893 65,261 67,893 70,524 73,156 75,787 79,210 82,629 86,050 87,500
10
7,690 8,040 8,827 9,613 10,400 11,054 11,707 12,360 13,134 13,907 14,680 15,520 16,360 17,200 18,134 19,067 20,000 21,000 22,000 23,000 24,600 26,200 27,700 29,200 30,700 33,000 36,800 40,300 44100, 48,500 53,000 55,250 57,500 59,750 62,000 64,500 67,000 69,500 72,000 75,250 78,500 81,750 85,000 87,500
1012
7,323 7,657 8,406 9,154 9,904 10527 11,149 11,770 12,508 13,244 13,980 14,780 15,580 16,380 17,269 18,158 19,046 19,998 20,951 21,903 23,427 24,950 26,379 27,807 29,236 31,426 35,045 38,378 41,996 46,187 50,472 52,615 54,757 56,900 59,043 61,423 63,804 66,185 68,566 71,661 74,756 77,851 80,946 84,469 87,500
11
6,990 7,308 8,024 8,738 9,454 10,048 10,642 11,235 11,939 12,641 13,344 14,108 14,871 15,635 16,484 17,332 18,180 19,089 20,000 20,907 22,361 23,816 25,179 26,543 27,906 29,997 33,451 36,633 40,087 44,087 48,177 50,222 52,268 54,313 56,358 58,631 60,903 63,176 65,448 68,402 71,357 74,311 77,265 80,628 83,992 87,446 87,500
1112
6,686 6,991 7,675 8,359 9,043 9,611 10,179 10,747 11,420 12,092 12,764 13,495 14,225 14,955 15,768 16,579 17,390 18,260 19,129 20,000 21,390 22,781 24,085 25,389 26,694 28,694 31,998 35,041 38,345 42,171 46,084 48,040 50,000 51,953 53,909 56,083 58,257 60,430 62,604 65,430 68,256 71,082 73,908 77,125 80,342 83,646 86,950
12
6,408 6,700 7,356 8,011 8,666 9,211 9,755 10,300 10,945 11,589 12,233 12,933 13,633 14,333 15,111 15,889 16,666 17,500 18,333 19,166 20,500 21,832 23,082 24,332 25,582 27,500 30,665 33,582 36,749 40,415 44,165 46,040 47,915 49,790 51,665 53,748 55,831 57,914 60,000 62,706 65,414 68,122 70,831 73,914 77,000 80,163 83,330
358
418
458 4316
518 4916
512 5
6 538
612 51316
678 614
738 658
778 7116
814 712
834 778
914 8516
958 834
1018 918
1058 9916
11 10
PH 156
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Total Travel* (in); Load (lbs)
13
5,915 6,184 6,790 7,394 8,000 8,503 9,005 9,507 10,103 10,697 11,292 11,938 12,584 13,230 13,949 14,666 15,384 16,153 16,922 17,692 18,922 20,153 21,307 22,461 23,614 25,384 28,307 31,000 33,922 37,306 40,768 42,498 44,230 45,960 47,690 49,613 51,536 53,459 56,382 57,882 60,382 62,882 65,382 68,228 71,074 74,000 76,920
1212
6,152 6,432 7,062 7,690 8,320 8,843 9,366 9,888 10,507 11,126 11,744 12,416 13,088 13,760 14,507 15,254 16,000 16,800 17,600 18,400 19,680 20,960 22,160 23,360 24,560 26,400 29,440 32,240 35,280 38,800 42,400 44,200 46,000 47,800 49,600 51,600 53,600 55,600 57,600 60,200 62,800 65,400 68,000 70,960 73,920 76,960 80,000
1312
5,696 5,955 6,538 7,120 7,703 8,188 8,671 9,155 9,728 10,301 10,873 11,496 12,118 12,740 13,432 14,123 14,814 15,555 16,295 17,036 18,221 19,406 20,517 21,628 22,739 24,443 27,258 29,850 32,665 35,924 39,257 40,924 42,590 44,257 45,923 47,775 49,627 51,479 53,330 55,738 58,145 60,552 62,960 65,700 68,441 71,255 74,070
14
5,492 5,742 6,304 6,966 7,428 7,895 8,361 8,828 9,380 9,932 10,484 11,084 11,684 12,284 12,951 13,618 14,284 14,998 15,712 16,427 17,569 18,712 19,783 20,855 21,926 23,569 26,283 28,782 31,496 34,639 37,583 39,460 41,067 42,673 44,280 46,066 47,851 49,637 51,422 53,744 56,065 58,386 60,707 63,350 65,992 68,706 71,420
1412
5,303 5,544 6,087 6,629 7,172 7,623 8,073 8,523 9,057 9,590 10,123 10,703 11,282 11,861 12,505 13,149 13,792 14,482 15,171 18,561 16,964 18,068 19,102 20,136 21,171 22,757 25,377 27,791 30,411 33,446 36,549 38,100 39,652 41,204 42,755 44,479 46,203 47,927 49,651 51,892 54,134 56,375 58,616 61,168 63,719 66,340 68,960
15
5,126 5,359 5,884 6,408 6,933 7,369 7,804 8,239 8,755 9,270 9,786 10,346 10,906 11,466 12,088 12,710 13,332 14,000 14,665 15,332 16,398 17,465 18,465 19,465 20,465 21,998 24,531 26,864 29,397 32,330 35,330 36,830 38,330 39,829 41,329 42,996 44,662 46,329 47,995 50,162 52,328 54,495 56,661 59,127 61,594 64,127 66,660
1512
4,961 5,187 5,694 6,201 6,709 7,131 7,552 7,973 8,473 8,971 9,470 10,012 10,554 11,096 11,698 12,300 12,902 13,547 14,192 14,837 15,869 16,902 17,869 18,837 19,805 21,288 23,740 25,998 28,449 31,287 34,190 35,642 37,093 39,545 40,000 41,609 43,221 44,834 46,447 48,544 50,640 52,737 54,834 57,220 59,607 62,059 64,510
16
4,806 5,025 5,517 6,008 6,500 6,909 7,317 7,725 8,209 8,692 9,175 9,700 10,225 10,750 11,334 11,917 12,500 13,125 13,750 14,375 15,375 16,375 17,313 18,250 19,188 20,626 23,000 25,188 27,563 30,313 33,125 34,531 35,938 37,344 38,750 40,313 41,875 43,438 45,000 47,031 49,063 51,094 53,125 55,438 57,750 60,125 62,500
1612
17
1712
18
1812
19
1912
20
32,119 33,482 34,845 36,209 37,572 39,087 40,602 42,117 43,632 45,602 47,571 49,541 51,510 53,752 55,994 58,297 60,600
31,175 32,498 33,822 35,145 36,468 37,939 39,409 40,880 42,350 44,262 46,174 48,085 50,000 52,173 54,350 56,585 58,820
30,285 31,570 32,856 34,141 35,427 36,855 38,284 39,712 41,141 42,998 44,855 46,712 48,569 50,683 52,797 54,969 57,140
29,442 30,691 31,941 33,191 34,441 35,830 37,219 38,607 39,996 41,801 43,607 45,412 47,218 49,273 51,328 53,439 55,550
28,647 29,863 31,080 32,295 33,511 34,862 36,214 37,565 38,916 40,673 42,429 44,186 45,943 47,942 49,942 52,000 54,050
27,894 29,078 30,262 31,446 32,631 33,946 35,262 36,578 37,894 39,604 41,315 43,025 44,736 46,683 48,630 50,630 52,630
27,179 28,332 29,486 30,640 31,794 33,076 34,358 35,640 36,922 38,588 40,255 41,921 43,588 45,485 47,383 49,331 51,280
26,500 27,625 28,750 29,875 31,000 32,250 33,500 34,750 36,000 37,625 39,250 40,875 42,500 44,350 46,200 48,100 50,000
1112 1038
12 101316
1238 11316
1278 1158
1338 12116
1378 1212
1414 1278
1434 13516
131116
1418
14916
141516
1538
1534
16316
1658
(1)
* Note: Total travel equals actual travel plus 1" or 20% (whichever is greater), rounded up to nearest 12" as applicable.
(2) Constant supports are readily available for travel and load not listed in this table. Dimensions and lug locations may vary from those shown on the following pages. (3) For Type F Upthrust see page PH-170 for standard travel and sizes. (4) Fig. 80-V are not available for sizes 1 thru 9.
PH 157
Constant Supports
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 80-V Type A
M J NOTE: HANGER MUST BE INSTALLED FLUSH WITH SUPPORTING STEEL v C L v v P v F ROD TAKE - OUT v v v v NOTE: HANGER MUST BE INSTALLED FLUSH WITH SUPPORTING STEEL v v
Model R
J v M v
v v
P v
D F
D v v v v I G v v N B v J v N v v v v
L Position
L
Sizes 10 63
Sizes 64 83
Type A of the gure 80-V vertical design model R Constant Support Hanger is designed for attachment to its supporting member by screwing a rod into a tapped hole in the top cap of hanger a distance equal to the P dimension plus 3 8 ". Sight holes are provided near the top of the casing to allow visible inspection for correct thread engagement of upper hanger rod.
Notes: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for
B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. M
Total Travel TT
5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 1112 or more or more 11 or less 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
Factors
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 3234 4678 6712 6912 878 16 1814 2818 4414 4614 2 218 434 8516 1316 112 112 258 334 578 712 712 2538 2538 858 1234 14 18 22316 27316 6716 8916 91316 1114 11 11
78
161516 1914 271516 30116 3238 37 4612 5134 7758 7734 78316 78516
84-110 See page PH-164 Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. "I" dimension for sizes10 through 63 equals "B" + "Q" Note: See the size selection chart (see page PH-154 through PH-157) for the "B" dimension.
Load (lbs)
J Rod Size *314"
0 800
12
801 1,500
58
1,501 2,540
34
2,541 4,000
1
4,001 6,100
114
13,401 18,300
2
18,301 24,700
214
24,701 31,000
212
31,001 39,000
234
PH 158
H Position v v
M Position
v v v v v v
L v
12
12
34
114 112
39,001 48,000
3
48,001 58,000
314*
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
v
HOLE SIZE K
v ROD TAKE - OUT
R
vH v
C L
v
D
D ROD TAKE - OUT F
v v
L I
v
L
v
L Position
L
M Position H Position
Sizes 10 63
Notes: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for
B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. M
Total Travel TT
5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 11 or less 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 3234 878 16 1814 2 218 434 112 258 334 112 2 3 858 1234 14 6716 8916 91316 138 158 212 112 112 114 K-hole & smaller, 112 138 K-hole and larger, 2 1516 K-hole, 112 118 thru 138 K-hole, 2 112 K-hole and larger, 3 3 334
38
58
34
19516 2158 31116 33316 3678 4112 5212 5734 7714 7738 771516 78116
50-63
4678
2818
8516
578
18
1114
414 + TT
64-74 75-83
6012 6114
3714 38
1316 112
712 712
412 358
2538 2538
22316 27316
11 11
2 212
534 + TT 534 + TT
84-110 See page PH-164 Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. "I" dimension for sizes10 through 63 equals "B" + "Q" * For constant support sizes 50-63 and 64-74 where 114" rod is required, check the "R" dimensions versus the Fig. 66 welded beam attachment dimensions for compatibility. Note: See the size selection chart (see page PH-154 through PH-157) for the "B" dimension.
Load (lbs)
J-Rod Size K-Hole *314"
0 800
12 1116
801 1,500
58 1316
1,501 2,540
34 1516
2,541 4,000
1 114
4,001 6,100
114 112
18,301 24,700
214 258
24,701 31,000
212 278
31,001 39,000
234 318
39,001 48,000
3 338
PH 159
Sizes 64 83
12
114 134
12
34
214
114 112
234 314
48,001 58,000
314* 358
Constant Supports
HOLE SIZE K v
v v
v
v
v
v
v
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 80-V Type C
HOLE SIZE K v ROD TAKE - OUT T v v T F v v v
Model R
S T v v M
v v
v v
C L
v
D F v v
v v
L I G v v v
L v v
H
L Position
L
M Position
H
H Position v v
v v
J v N v v
Sizes 10 63
Sizes 64 83
Type C is furnished with a pair of lugs for attachment to the building structure. These lugs permit the use of an eye rod or a single plate for attachment where headroom is limited.
Notes: See load travel tables,see page PH-154 through PH-157 for
B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. M
Total Travel TT
5 or less 512 512 612 or more or more or more 5 or less 6 or less 11 or less
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 3234 878 16 1814 2 218 434 112 258 334 112 2 3 858 1234 14 6716 8916 91316 138 158 212 112 112
114 K-hole & smaller, 112 138 K-hole and larger, 2
1516 K-hole, 112 118 thru 138 K-hole, 2 112 K-hole and larger, 3 38
58
34
50-63
4678
2818
8516
578
18
1114
60 6012
3634 3714
1316 112
712 712
5 412
2538 2538
22316 27316
11 11
3 3
3 334
12
Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. "I" dimension for sizes10 through 63 equals "B" + "Q" Note: See the size selection chart (see page PH-154 through PH-157) for the "B" dimension.
Load (lbs)
J-Rod Size K-Hole Size S *314"
0 800
12 1116 78
801 1,500
58 1316
1,501 2,540
34 1516
2,541 4,000
1 114 158
4,001 6,100
114 112 2
6,101 9,400
112 134 238
9,401 13,400
134 2 258
13,401 18,300
2 238 278
18,301 24,700
214 258 318
1116
114
PH 160
Factors
19516 2158 31116 33316 3678 4112 5212 5734 7714 7738 771516 78116
24,701 31,000
212 278 338
HOLE SIZE K v
v R T v
D v
12
12
12
414 + TT
34
534 + TT 534 + TT
114 112
31,001 39,000
234 318 358
39,001 48,000
3 338 378
48,001 58,000
314* 358 418
vH
v v
v v
M
v
v v
34
114 134
214
234 314*
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
C L
X Y v v
v
v
L v v G v
J B v
Type D rests on top of structural steel while most of the Constant Support itself hangs between or below the supporting beams. The depth of the beam is limited by the P dimension. Dimension P can be varied on special order, however, P dimension shown is maximum for the hanger.
Notes: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for
B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. M
Total Travel TT
Available in Fig. 81-H only 1878 2812 3234 4678 878 16 1814 2818 2 218 434 8516 112 258 334 578 858 1234 14 18 6716 8916 91316 1114 138 158 212 3 41516 1212 1314 2412 238 238 258 278 112 112 2 3 1034 1478 1634 21 3 3 4 6
34
5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 11 or less 1112 or more
12
34
78
12
118 138
12
34
*Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. "I" dimension for sizes10 through 63 equals "B" + "Q" Note: See the size selection chart (see page PH-154 through PH-157) for the "B" dimension.
Load (lbs)
J Rod Size
0 800
12
801 1,500
58
1,501 2,540
34
2,541 4,000
1
4,001 6,100
114
6,101 9,400
112
9,401 13,400
134
13,401 18,300
2
18,301 24,700
214
PH 161
Constant Supports
v
v v
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 80-V Type E
v v
Model R
C L
v v
D
L
D F
v v
B
L
Sizes 1 to 63
Sizes 64 74
Sizes 75 83
Notes: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for
B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Dia. M
Angle Size
Total Travel TT
Available in Fig. 81-H Only 1878 2812 3234 4678 62 6212 112
1316
878 16 1814
2 218 434
58
5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 1112 or more or more 11 or less 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
58
178 334
38
1316
514
112
84-110 Not Available Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. Rod take-out is measured from the bottom of the supporting angles to the center of the load coupling site hole. "I" dimension for sizes10 through 63 equals "B" + "Q" Note: See the size selection chart (see page PH-154 through PH-157) for the "B" dimension.
0 800
12
801 1,500
58
1,501 2,540
34
2,541 4,000
1
4,001 6,100
114
6,101 9,400
112
9,401 13,400
134
13,401 18,300
2
18,301 24,700
214
24,701 31,000
212
31,001 39,000
234
39,001 48,000
3
PH 162
12
v
12 12 34
v
v
v v
I
G
v
v
34
114 112
48,001 58,000
314*
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
C-C ROD DIMENSION AS SPECIFIED Q v v v v
v
H Position
H
M Position L Position
v v v L F V G v v v
Dia M
Not available 1878 2812 878 16 1 114 2 218 434 8516 112 258 334 578 858 1234 14 18 6716 8916 2916 3916 312 4 512 612 51316 9 1034 1434 31516 618 8 101516 4 @ 5.4 6 @ 10.5 10 @ 15.3 12 @ 20.7 30 42 48 48 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 11 or less 1112 or more 111116 14 161316 1834 1914 2378 2458 30 134 + TT 238 + TT 314 + TT 414 + TT
12 34
Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position. Note: See the size selection chart (see page PH-154 through PH-157) for the "B" dimension.
Load (lbs)
J Rod Size
0 800
12
801 1,500
58
1,501 2,540
34
2,541 4,000
1
4,001 6,100
114
taken in sizing the individual hanger units. The center-to-center rod dimension must be specied when ordering. The minimum C-C dimension can be determined as follows: B plus Q > Y: (O.D. of pipe covering) + 2Q. B plus Q < Y: (O.D. of pipe covering) + 2 (Y - B).
Note: If U-bolt is used to fasten pipe to channels, C-C of U-bolt tangents plus one washer plate width cannot be greater than C-C of the hanger rods minus 2 (V minus B).See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
C-C
Total Travel TT
Factors
12
12
34
6,101 9,400
112
9,401 13,400
134
13,401 18,300
2
18,301 24,700
214
PH 163
Constant Supports
HH
M M
L L
v v
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 80-V Types A, B and C Model R, Sizes 84 to 110
TYPE B
K HOLE SIZE
T
W
TYPE A
Note: "B" Dimensions is a function of total travel ("G" + "B" should not be assumed as equal to "C" Dimension) Types A, B, and C sizes 84 through 110, for large loads and long
travels, provide for basically the same methods of upper attachment as sizes 10 to 83 shown Type A on page PH-158, Type B page PH-159 and Type C see page PH-160.
Notes: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for
B dimension. For weights see page PH-172.
Fig. 80-V, Types A,B,C Sizes 84 to 110: Dimensions (in) C Hanger Sizes L Type Type A&B C
16 24 15 23
E D Type A&B
4 4
G Type C
412 412
Type A
4534 5512 5612 6538
84-94 95-110
7834 100
4934 64
6 6
24 24
1012 1112
3 312
12 1312
*Rod take-out = (factor) - (.75 x TT), for Lever in high position Note: See the size selection chart (see page PH-154 through PH-157) for the "B" dimension.
Load (lbs)
J & K-Rods K-Hole R S T (Type B) T (Type C) W
14,376 18,300
2 238 3 278
34
18,301 24,700
214 258 3 318
34
24,701 31,000
212 278 4 338 1 8
31,001 39,000
234 318 4 358 1 8
39,001 48,000
3 338 4 378 1 8
48,001 58,000
314* 358 412 418 1 9
PH 164
v v v
TYPE C
v T v
Type B&C
5434 6412 66 7478
Max
334 334
58,001 69,000
312* 378 412 438 112 114 9
69,001 87,500
334* 418 412 458 134 114 9
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
L v v D v F
H
M
J+14"
C K
Type A of the Figure 81- H Horizontal Design Model R Constant Support Hanger is designed for attaching to its supporting member by screwing two rods into taped holes in the top of the hanger from a distance equal to the "P" dimension plus 38". Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
N M
Rod Min
12
Dia. Max
12
1- 9 10 - 18 19 - 34 35 - 49
1 1 114 134
78
1316
131516 171516 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
1234 15516 1078 1314 1634 1878 2118 2534 241516 241516 3014 34716 34916 3612 3658
12
1116
12
34
58
118 138
12
114 134
1116
12
71116
171116
1114
134
414 + TT
34
214
64 - 74 75 - 83 84 - 110
3534 3534
3 314
314 358
514 5
22316 27316
11 11
3716 414
534 + TT 534 + TT
114 112
234 314
Load (lbs)
J Rod Size *314"
0 800
12
801 1,500
58
1,501 2,540
34
2,541 4,000
1
J-Rod and K-Rod Selection Chart 4,001 6,101 9,401 13,401 6,100 9,400 13,400 18,300
114 112 134 2
18,301 24,700
214
24,701 31,000
212
31,001 39,000
234
39,001 48,000
3
48,001 58,000
314*
PH 165
Constant Supports
v v
P vv
v
L
v vv v
v v
v vv
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 81-H Type B
L v E v v R H v v C HOLE SIZE K T E v v
v
Model R
W 2
2W W
v v
v v
W 2
R v v
v F
H
M
D v
v v
J v
Type B is furnished with two lugs one at each end of the hanger frame. These lugs permit use of Fig. 66 welded beam attachments, clevises or angle clips for attachment where headroom is limited. Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
Notes: Also available for single rod suspension as indicated above. When ordering specify for single rod suspension. See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary form that shown.
L
131516 171516 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
C
512 912 712 1012 934 1378 1012 1812 1338 2138 2138 1514 2034 1434 2014
1-9 10 - 18 19 - 34 35 - 49
78
112 112 2 3
12
58
1116
638
1738
1114
64 - 74 75 - 83
3534 3534
314 312
314 358
5 434
412 5
22316 27316
11 11
84 - 110 See page PH-171 * Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position.
0 800
12 1116
801 1,500
58 1316
1,501 2,540
34 1516
2,541 4,000
1 114 112
12
4,001 6,100
114 112 2
58
6,101 9,400
112 134 212
34
9,401 13,400
134 2 212
34
13,401 18,300
2 238 3
34
18,301 24,700
214 258 3
34
114
14*
114
14*
114
38
212
212
212
PH 166
v vv
N M
J-Rod Factors
1458 17316 13116 15716 1978 22 2558 3018 301116 301116 36 4238 4212 4534 4578 534 + TT 534 + TT 114 112 234 314** 414 + TT
34
v v
Max
12
12
34
12
114 134
12
214
24,701 31,000
212 278 4 1 8
31,001 39,000
234 318 4 1 8
39,001 48,000
3 338 4 1 8
48,001 58,000
314** 358 412 1 9
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
S v L v E R H C HOLE SIZE K W v v v v v v v
v v v
2W v W
T v v v R H
D v v F
W/2 v
v v
J v
N M
Type C is furnished with two pair of lugs, one pair of lugs at each of the hanger frame. These lugs permit the use of two eye rods or two single plates for attachment where headroom is limited. Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
Notes: Also available for single rod suspension as indicated above. When ordering specify for single rod suspension. See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Total Travel TT
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 8 or less 812 to 11 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
J-Rod L
131516 171516 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
C
512 912 712 1012 812 1258 912 1712 1338 2138 2138 1334 1914 1234 1814
Factors
1458 17316 13116 15716 1978 22 2558 3018 301116 301116 36 4238 4212 4534 4534
78
112 112 2 3
12
12
34
58
12
114 134
1116
12
50 - 63
26316
1516
638
171116
1114
414 + TT
34
214
64 - 74 75 - 83
3534 3534
4 412
314 358
414 334
412 5
22316 27316
11 11
534 + TT 534 + TT
114 112
234 314
84 - 110 See page PH-171 * Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position.
0 800
12 1116
801 1,500
58 1316
1,501 2,540
34 1516
2,541 4,000
1 114 112 158
12
4,001 6,100
114 112 2 2
58
6,101 9,400
112 134 212 238
34
9,401 13,400
134 2 212 258
34
13,401 18,300
2 238 3 278
34
18,301 24,700
214 258 3 318
34
24,701 31,000
212 278 4 338 1 8
31,001 39,000
234 318 4 358 1 8
39,001 48,000
3 338 4 378 1 8
48,001 58,000
314** 358 412 418 1 9
114
78 14*
114 1116
14*
114 114
38
212
212
212
PH 167
Constant Supports
v v
v vv
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 81-H Type D Model R
v v
v Y v v
v F
H
Fig. 81-H Type D: Dimensions (inches) J-Rod Hanger Sizes D E F G M N X Y Angle Size Bracket Hole Dia. Total Travel TT
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less 612 or more 8 or less 50 - 63 26316 2
1516
1- 9 10 - 18 19 - 34 35 - 49
1 314 112 2
78
34
916
12
78
34
58
118 138
34
1116
78
738
171116
1114
158
1458
4x4x
38
138
812
to 11
11 or more 64 - 74 75 - 83 3534 3534 3 3 314 358 514 434 22316 27316 11 11 2 2 15 15 4 x 6 x 12 4 x 6 x 12 158 158 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
84 - 110 Not available * Rod take-out = factor - (TT / 2), for lever in high position.
Load (lbs)
J Rod Size *314"
0 800
12
801 1,500
58
1,501 2,540
34
2,541 4,000
1
4,001 6,100
114
13,401 18,300
2
PH 168
Type D may be bolted directly under steel. Sizes 1 to 9 are furnished with swivel eye and turnbuckle instead of yoke and coupling.
B NOTES: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 J for B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. N M Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown. vv v v v
Factors
131516 171516 18716 201516 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5712 63 5712 63
6 10 312 6 912 1358 1012 1812 1538 2338 2338 1534 2114 1534 2114
1338 151516 111316 14316 1734 1978 201316 25716 27116 27116 3238 3838 3812 4114 4138
12
34
12
114 134
12
414 + TT
34
214
534 + TT 534 + TT
114 112
234 314
18,301 24,700
214
24,701 31,000
212
31,001 39,000
234
39,001 48,000
3
48,001 58,000
314*
v v
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R
L v
v
ROD TAKE - OUT K v v v FOUR HOLES FOR BOLTS v
v
J
X Y N X v v v v v v
of the supporting steel. Increase rod take-out by the depth of the steel.
Notes: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for
B dimension. For weights see page PH-172. Location of travel indicator and contour of side plate may vary from that shown.
Fig. 81-H Type E: Dimensions (in) Hanger Sizes Angle Size Bkt. Hole Dia.
916
Total Travel TT
4 or less 412 or more 5 or less 512 or more 5 or less 512 or more 6 or less
1-9 10 - 18 19 - 34 35 - 49
78
58
131516 171516 18716 21716 261516 31116 31916 39916 45916 53916 53916 5312 63 5712 63
518 71116 134 4116 338 512 478 912 678 678 1214 1118 1114 9 918
12
58
34
12
34
58
58
34
12
114 134
1116
91316 1512
1316
78
612 or more 8 or less 812 to 11 1112 or more 1012 or less 11 or more 1012 or less 11 or more
12
50 - 63
26316
1516
738
171116
1114
1934
1516
141116
3 x 3 x 38
138
414 + TT
34
214
64 - 74 75 - 83
3534 3534
314 358
514 434
22316 27316
11 11
2678 3178
1916 1916
141516 141516
158 158
534 + TT 534 + TT
114 112
234 314
84 - 110 Not available * Rod take-out = (factor) - (TT / 2), for lever in high position.
0 800
1 2
801 1,500
5 8
1,501 2,540
3 4
2,541 4,000
1
4,001 6,100
1 1 4
6,101 9,400
1 1 2
9,401 13,400
1 3 4
13,401 18,300
2
18,301 24,700
2 1 4
24,701 31,000
2 1 2
31,001 39,000
2 3 4
39,001 48,000
3
48,001 58,000
3 1 4
PH 169
Constant Supports
v
v
L
v
vv
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 81-H Type F Upthrust
The Upthrust is for support of piping or equipment from below. It has a base ange for fastening to the oor or beams. The load is supported during hydrostatic testing by means of (4) positioning studs. After testing the nuts are moved to either end of the stud to prevent interference during operation. The Upthrust constant support is available for loads up to 24,463 (lbs). Corrosion resistant units are available either galvanized or carbon-zinc painted.
Model R
T.T.
v
10 -18
2.0 2.5 3.0 3.5 4.0 4.5 1618
19 - 34
35 - 49
50 - 63
v v
v v
A* TAKE OUT
v v
E v
D K
v v v v G
Total Travel TT
2-6 2-8 212 - 10 3 - 10
B
1078
C
1178 1334 1614 1914
D
9 13 17 1612
E
212 218 2 458
PH 170
v F DIA. 4 PLACES P
2712
v
v v v v
8.5
v
3158
34
* For down travel: Take-Out = "A" + (1/2) Actual Travel For up travel: Take-Out = "A" - (1/2) Actual Travel
H
8
J
12 14 17 19
K
14 1714 21 2534
L
22716 3158 3814 52
M
814 1212 1358 1738
N
5 8 10
P
12 58 34
Q
1378 1638 1934 2314
34
2 358
10 13 1134
78
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Model R, Sizes 84 to 110
K HOLE SIZE
K HOLE SIZE
TYPE A
K Z
3"
Notes: See load travel tables, see page PH-154 through PH-157 for B dimension. For weights see page PH-172.
TYPE E
Y Q
v v
Fig. 81-H, Types A, B C and E: Dimensions (in) C Hanger Size L Type Type A&B C D E Type Type A&B C F G Type Type H K M A&B E &C N P Q X Y Z Factors J-Rod Total Travel Type Type Type Min Rod Dia. Thd TT A B&C E Lgth Min Max
912 or less 10 or more 14 or less 1412 or more 4534 5512 5612 6538 5434 6412 66 7478 2158 3138 1758 2658 10 2 13 12 212 15 334 334
84- 94
7634
28
2712
4934
412
118
14
6 21 24 1012
16 34
13
27
95- 110
100
49
4812
64
412
138
2834
834
Load (lbs)
J & K-Rods K-Hole R S T (Type B) T (Type C) W
14,376 18,300
2 238 3 278
34
18,301 24,700
214 258 3 318
34
24,701 31,000
212 278 4 338 1 8
31,001 39,000
234 318 4 358 1 8
39,001 48,000
3 338 4 378 1 8
48,001 58,000
314 358 412 418 1 9
58,001 69,000
312 378 412 438 112 114 9
69,001 87,500
334 418 412 458 134 114 9
PH 171
N M
TYPE B
v
M N
TYPE C
v v
Constant Supports
v
v
v
R
v
R
v
v v
v
v
vv
v v v v
v v v v v
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Fig. 80-V and 81-H
Fig 80-V Hanger Sizes 1 to 3 4 to 6 7 to 9 10 to 12 13 to 15 16 to 18 19 to 20 21 to 23 24 to 26 27 to 29 30 to 32 33 to 34 35 to 37 38 to 40 41 to 43 44 to 46 47 to 49 50 to 51 52 to 54 55 to 57 58 to 60 61 to 63 64 to 65 66 to 68 69 to 71 72 to 74 75 to 77 78 to 80 81 to 83 84 to 85 86 to 88 89 to 90 91 to 92 93 to 94 95 to 98 99 to 102 103 to 106 107 to 110 Types A, B, C, D & E Net 62 65 70 163 165 172 180 187 195 300 315 332 343 360 601 626 665 706 745 1,468 1,568 1,653 1,753 2,360 2,430 2,570 2,725 2,870 3,070 3,155 3,255 4,350 4,675 5,300 5,800 Shipping 67 70 75 171 173 180 188 195 203 312 327 344 355 372 661 686 725 766 805 1,568 1,668 1,753 1,853 2,460 2,530 2,670 2,845 2,990 3,190 3,275 3,375 4,500 4,825 5,450 5,950 Type G s Net 160 166 176 371 375 389 405 419 435 676 706 740 762 796 1,278 1,328 1,406 1,488 1,566 Types A, B, C, D & E Net 18 21 23 52 55 60 150 152 159 167 174 182 280 295 312 323 340 511 536 575 616 655 1,225 1,325 1,410 1,520 1,970 2,020 2,180 2,310 2,455 2,655 2,740 2,840 3,925 4,250 4,875 5,350 Shipping 20 23 25 57 60 65 158 160 167 175 182 190 292 307 324 335 352 571 596 635 676 715 1,325 1,425 1,510 1,620 2,070 2,120 2,280 2,430 2,575 2,775 2,860 2,960 4,075 4,400 5,025 5,500 Net 174 177 182 415 417 424 432 439 447 640 655 672 683 700 1,181 1,206 1,245 1,286 1,325
PH 172
Return to TOC
CONSTANT SUPPORTS
Check List for Requesting a Quote or Ordering
Page ___ of ____
Constant Support
Finish: Standard Primer: ______________ Galvanized: ________________ Special Coating: _________________________________ Quantity: ______________ Figure No.: Options are: 80-V, 81-H
or: C-80-V, C-81-H
Size: Options are: #1 through #110 (Size #1 through #9 available in 81-H only) Type: Options are: A through G* (Type F Upthrust available in 81-H only, Type G available in 80-V only) Actual Travel (AT): _________ (inches) Total Travel (TT)**: _________ (inches) Direction of Travel: _________ + (up) or (down) Load: _________ (lbs) J Dimension (rod diameter): _________ (inches) (Not required for Type F) Mark Number: ____________________ (if required) Travel Stops: Are always Included Lifting Lugs: Yes: _________ No: __________
Available on sizes 10 and larger.
Notes:
* Type G Constants must also include the C-to-C dimension & the load per spring. ** Total Travel = Actual travel + 1" or 20% whichever is greater rounded up to the next one half inch increment.
PH 173
Constant Supports
Anvil International Precision Park 160 Frenchtown Rd. North Kingstown, RI 02852
For technical information regarding Constant Supports Call or Fax: Fax Number: (401) 886-3056 Phone Number: (401) 886-3025
Return to TOC
HORIZONTAL TRAVELER
Fig. 170
Size Range: Available in four sizes to take loads to 20,700 (lbs).
All sizes provide for 12" of horizontal travel.
Horizontal Traveler
Approvals: Complies with MSS-SP-69 (Type 58). Features: Highly economical Minimum friction Virtually dust proof Compact designed for minimum head room Versatile Installation: Shipped ready for installation. Attach to the
supporting steel by welding around the frame.
Ordering: Specify size number, gure number, name and "H" dimension, if required. Horizontal travelers will be designed for special loads, travels or dual directional travel upon request.
The Anvil Fig. 170 horizontal traveler facilitates the supporting of piping systems subject to linear horizontal movements where head room is limited. Designed for use with Anvil Variable Spring Hangers or Constant Supports it can also be used in conjunction with a rigid type hanger assembly.
A v B v v C
H D
Maximum Load
3,770 6,230 11,630 20,700
PH 174
v W v v v Field Weld T v
Weight
15 37 69 102
A
2 1 2 3 1 2 5 6
B
1 5 8 2 5 8 3 3 1 2
C
5 3 8 7 7 8 1012 1212
D
2 1 2 3 1 2 5 6
H Max
1 1 8 1 3 8 1 3 4 2 3 8
L
1518 1638 1778 1918
T
3 4
W
4 5 8 6 7 8 8716 9 7 8
1 1 1 2
Return to TOC
Fig. 296 Fig. 301: With Adjustable Preload Fig. C-296, Fig. C-301: Corrosion Resistant
Size Range: Preloads from 50 to 1,800 pounds and
maximum forces from 200 to 7,200 pounds.
Service: Recommended for controlling vibration; absorbing shock loading; guiding or restraining the movement of pipe resulting from thermal expansion; bracing a pipe line against sway. Approvals: Complies with Federal Specication A-A-1192A (Type 55)
WW-H-171E (Type 55) and MSS SP-69 (Type 50).
Installation: Shipped ready for installation (see line cuts of Fig. 297, Fig. 298, Fig. 302 and Fig. 303 on page PH-177 for typical installed hanger assemblies). Adjustment: The sway brace should be in the neutral position when the system is
hot and operating, at which time both spring plates should be in contact with the end plates. If they are not, the sway brace should be adjusted to the neutral position by use of the load coupling.
Features: Vibration is dampened with an instantaneous opposing force bringing the pipe
back to normal position.
A single pre-loaded spring provides two way movement. One spring saves space and simplies design. Spring has 3-inch travel in either direction. Accurate neutral adjustment assured. A tight tting connection at rear bracket and clamp. Additional Features Fig. 301:
The Fig. 301 sway brace is adjustable from the initial preload to the maximum capacity of the unit selected. It is equipped with a load-deection scale to facilitate preload adjustment. Preload adjustment reduces spring travel accordingly.
Ordering: Specify gure, name and sway brace size. The Anvil Fig. 296 and Fig. 301 consist of the sway brace only. Available corrosion resistant as Fig. C-296 and Fig. C-301. Preload adjustment Fig. 301: Turn the preload adjustment nut until desired preload is indicated. Turn thrust nut until it is in contact with the spring plate. Lock in position. Indicated deection must be greater than thermal movement.
ADJ. NUT
v v
COUPLING
PH 175
Return to TOC
D
v
2"
2" M
2"
2"
v
R K P F
v v
v v
P F L
Fig. 296
Fig. 296: Loads Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Sway Brace Size
1 2 3 4 5 6 6 to 30 112 to 24
Fig. 301
Pipe Size
Weight
22 25 36 64 79 95
1358 1
3 4
8 7 8 9 5 8 13 1112 13 15 11316 1 1 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
4 1 2
1438 1734 17
1 1 2
1 1 2
6 5 8
1812 2012
Fig. 301: Loads Weights (lbs) Dimensions (in) Preload and Spring Scale lb/in
50 112 to 24 150 450 900 6 to 30 1,350 1,800
Pipe Size
Dia. Hole
D Thickness
Length F
1 2 3 4 5 6
23 26 38 67 82 98
20 1
3 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2
4 1 2
1 1 2
1 1 2
6 5 8
251316 271316
PH 176
v v
v
EYE
END PLATE
SPRING PLATE
ROD COUPLING
v
v
Return to TOC
Fig. 297 and Fig. 298 Sway Brace Assembly Fig. 302 and Fig. 303: With Adjustable Preload Fig. C-297, Fig. C-298, Fig. C-302 and Fig. C-303: Corrosion Resistant
The Fig. 297 and Fig. 302 consist of a structural attachment, two studs, the Sway Brace, extension piece up to 2 0" in length as required, and a modied Fig. 295 pipe clamp. The Fig. 298 and Fig. 303 consist of a structural attachment, two studs, the Sway Brace, adjustable extension piece 2 1 in length or over as required, an adapter and a toleranced pipe clamp.
OVERALL LENGTH
3" STUD
v
REAR BRACKET
3"
EXTENSION PIECE
v
v STUD E
W
v
FIELD WELD
FIG. 296 Body
v
C L
v
FIG. 298
REAR BRACKET
v
ADAPTER
v STUD E
number, name, Sway Brace size, pipe size, W dimension. Available corrosion resistant as Fig. C-297, C-298, C-302 and C-303.
3"
3"
v v
REAR BRACKET
F Fig 301
STUD
v
W FIELD WELD
v
ADAPTER
OVERALL LENGTH
Fig. 297, 298, 302, 303, C-297, C-298, C-302 and C-303: Dimensions (in) E Pipe Size
1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30
Size 1 4 Carbon
4 1 8 5 1 8 5 3 8 5 15 16 6 3 16 6 1 2 7 8 9 16 9 9 16 10 5 8 11 5 8 12 1 1 1 6 13 1 1 1 6 14 1 1 1 6 15 7 8 17 7 8
Fig. 297, 298, 302, 303, C-297, C-298, C-302 and C-303: Dimensions (in) W Strut Size Fig. 297, 302 Min
7 15 16 8 9 16 8 9 16 9 11 16 9 13 16
Max
24 24 24 24 24
REAR BRACKET
STUD
FIG. 301 Body
OVERALL LENGTH W
v
C L
FIG. 302
EXTENSION PIECE
v
v STUD E
FIG. 303
C L
v
v
STUD
Max
90 3 1 6 86 1 1 1 6 79 3 1 6 74 1 3 1 6 61 1 3 1 6 46 1 3 1 6
PH 177
C L
FIG. 297
v v
v v
Return to TOC
Service: Used to restrain movement of piping while allowing for movement in the other two directions. How to size:
(1) Select size consistent with max. load to be restrained. (2) C to C is obtained by subtracting E and A from the distance from structural steel to center of pipe. Verify that the calculated C to C is within the min/max limits. (3) Determine W dimension by: W=(C to C)-2F.
Installation: Shipped assembled. Securely fasten bracket to structure, make necessary adjustment in overall length,
and fasten clamp to pipe.
Features: Effective under either tensile or compressive force. Provides 31 2 " (Fig. 211) or 2" (Fig. 640) of eld adjustment in either direction. Self-aligning bushings permits 5 misalignment or angular motion. Bushings are coated with a dry lubricant. Ordering: Specify gure number, assembly size, name, option number, normal pipe size or special O.D., and W dimension.
Alloy pipe clamps are available as a special order. For restraint parallel to the pipe axis using two sway strut assemblies, a riser clamp is available. If a riser clamp is required, consult the nearest Anvil representative for information about this clamp.
Size A
2716 2916 21116 4 1 8 5 1 8 5 3 8 51516 6316 6 1 2 7 3 4 8 3 8 9 3 8 1012
Size B&C
6 3 8 7 7 1 4 7 3 4 8 3 8 9 3 8 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
Size 1&2
6 3 8 7 7 1 4 7 3 4 8 3 8 9 3 8 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
Size 3
8 1 8 8 3 8 9 1 8 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
Size 4
9 1 8 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
Size 5
Size 6
1178 1258 1414 1538 16 1718 1814 1914 2134 25 2818
Size 7
1414 1538 1614 1712 1812 1934 2134 25 2818
Size 8
1614 1714 18 19 2014 2112 24 28 3114
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
10
PH 178
Return to TOC
Fig. 211, Fig. C-211 Fig. 640, Fig. C-640: Field Welded Strut
OPTION 1
T
D1
OPTION 2
A R F C-C 312" FOR FIG. 211 C-C 2" FOR FIG. 640 W (W = C TO C - 2F)
E F
OPTION 3
Fig. 211, C-211, Fig. 640 & Fig. C-640: Load (lbs) Dimensions (in) Fig. 211 & Fig. 640 Size Load s
650 1,500 4,500 8,000 11,630 15,700 20,700 27,200 33,500 68,200 120,000
A
1
F
3716
D1
1 1 4
N
1 4
R
5 8
S
5 8
T Max Min
0.374 0.372 0.749 0.747 0.749 0.747 0.999 0.997 0.999 0.997 1.249 1.247 1.249 1.247 1.499 1.497 1.749 1.747 1.999 1.997 2.499 2.497 60 108 1612
F
21116
A B C 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
1 1 1 2
1 1
4716 2 2 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 1 2 1 3 4 3 2 3 2 1 4 2 1 2 4 3 4 6 5 3 4 7 1 4 8 3 4 11 9 1 8 14 4 5 6 3 4 7 5 8 6 1 8 7 7 8 6 5 3 4 3 2 1 2 41316
2 3 8
5 8
14716
31116
1 3 8 2 7 8 5
3 4
1 3 8
4 1 8 4 1 4 5 5 1 4 6 6 7 8 8 1014
3316
3 4
1 1 2
11116
6 6 3 4 7 5 8 8 3 4 11
5 8 3 4
4 1 4 5 3 8 6 1 4 8 3 4
1 1 4 2 1 2 1 3 4 2 3 3 1 2
2 2 3 8 3 3 3 8
22 2334 28 3434
2 1 4 4 3 4
s Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization. Fig. 640 shipped at maximum length C-C, eld cut to "W" to suit, unless otherwise specied.
PH 179
C L
Return to TOC
How to size:
(1) Select size consistent with max. load to be restrained. (2) C to C is obtained by subtracting E and A from the distance from structural steel to center of pipe. Verify that the calculated C to C in within the min/max limits. (3) Determine W dimension by: W=(C-C)-2F.
Installation: Shipped assembled. Securely fasten bracket to structure, make necessary adjustment in overall length, and fasten clamp to pipe. Features: Assembly provides a shorter C to C dimension. Effective under either tensile or compressive force. Self-aligning bushings permit 5 misalignment or angular
motion. Bushings are coated with a dry lubricant.
Ordering: Specify assembly size, gure number, name, nish, pipe O.D. or option number, if other than standard, and load. Ex: Size A-1, Fig. 222 mini sway strut 103 4 O.D. pipe, 650#. Alloy pipe clamps are available as a special order. For restraint parallel to the pipe axis using two sway strut assemblies, a riser clamp is available. Contact your Anvil representative for information about this clamp. Note: The rear bracket assembly can be ordered separately
E-Take Out: Dimensions (in) Pipe Size
3 4
Size A
2716 2916 21116 4 1 8 5 1 8 5 3 8 51516 6316 6 1 2 7 3 4 8 3 8 9 3 8 1012
Size B&C
6 3 8 7 7 1 4 7 3 4 8 3 8 9 3 8 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
Size 1
6 3 8 7 7 1 4 7 3 4 8 3 8 9 3 8 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
PH 180
Return to TOC
D1
OPTION 1
OPTION 2
A R B
C-C W F
E C-C C L SIZES C-1, C-2, 1-1 & 1-2 PIPE CLAMP (INCLUDES STUD)
D S
OPTION 3
Load s
C-C Max
6 5 8 8 1 2 1314 6 1 2 7 3 4 81116 101516 15716 19916 8 7 8 1058 1178 1518 2158
F W Min
5 3 8 6 1 2 8 1 2 6 6 5 8 7916 81116 101516 15716 8 8 7 8 1014 1178 1518
Max
21316 4 1 4 6 1 4 2 7 8 3 1 2 31316 41516 7316 9 1 4 31116 4916 41316 6716 91116
Min
1916 2 1 4 1 1 2 2 3 8 2 3 8 21116 21116 21116 5 1 8 21316 21316 3316 3316 3316 2 5 8 3116 51316 1 1 2 2 1 8 2 3 4 3 7 8 6 1 8 8316 21516 31316 41316 6716 91116
Rod End
D1
T Nom.
3 4
1 1 4
1 4
5 8
5 8
3 8
1316
1 3 8
2 1 2
2 3 8
5 8
1 3 8
1 3 8
3 4
2 1 8
1 1 4
2 1 2
2 7 8
3 4
1916
1 3 8
2 1 4
s Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization.
PH 181
Return to TOC
Replacement Strut
Ordering: Specify size, gure number, name, nish and W dimension. Note: The Fig. 210 has the same load rating as the snubber it replaces.
T DIA.
T DIA.
W Max
66 77 100 120 120 120 120 130
F Min
2316 3116 3 3 8 4 4 3 4 5 3 4 6 1 2 6 3 8 9 12916 141316 1558 1778 1978 2212 27
Min
4 5 8 6716 8116 7 5 8 8 3 8 8 3 8 9 1 2 1414
Max
6158 7078 9314 112 11012 10812 107 11714 10434
T Nominal
3 8 1 2 3 4
Fig. 306/307
1 4 K
& 1 2 K 1K 3K
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 1 1 2 2
10K 35K
120 10 7 5 8 2514 Note: The Fig. 210 has the same load rating as the snubber it replaces
PH 182
Return to TOC
LIMIT STOP
Limit Stop
Features: Totally passive Unrestricted thermal movement Simple installation Simplied inspection visual ISO-9001 qualied Pin-to-pin: up to 120" Materials: Smaller sizes (up to 10,000 lb. Load) are of stainless steel construction and utilize
internal body threads for adjusting gaps. For larger sizes, carbon steel is used, and the gaps are adjusted with internal spacer washers. Hard chrome, as well as other platings and coating, are utilized to meet any environment.
Size
1 2 11 3 12 4 13 14 5 15 16 6 18 19 20 21
Stroke *
4 4 5 5 5 6 5 5 6 5 5 6 5
Pin Dia
3 8 1 2 3 4
Max.
141 8 161 2 193 4 211 2 205 8 263 16 227 8 247 8 33 271 2 301 4 3813 16 341 2
1 11 4 11 2 13 4 2
2 1 2
PH 183
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Fig. 3306 Fig. 3307: With Extension Piece
Size Range: Six standard sizes with load ratings from 350 to 50,000 pounds. Finish: Basic unit is corrosion resistant salt bath nitrided. Attachments are painted
with semi gloss primer, carbo zinc or other.
Hydraulic Snubber
Fig. 3306
Pressurized reservoirs Continuous operation at 150 F with brief transients to 350 F Factory calibrated valves Rapid, positive valve closure Special design minimizes the lost motionwhich results from the shifting and seating of piston seals less than 2% of rated load for larger sizes
Unlocked resisting force is less than 17 1/2 pounds for sizes 1/4 and 1/2 and Stable non-ammable, long life hydraulic uid Self-aligning bushings permit 5 misalignment or angular motion.
Bushings are coated with a dry lubricant.
Choice of coating (paint, primer, carbo zinc, epoxy, plating or other) for
attachments.
Applications: Direct replacement for Fig. 306/307 Pacic Scientic (PSA) mechanical
snubbers: Exact load ratings, exact pin sizes, exact stroke lengths and exact pin-to-pin dimensions. The cross sectional dimensions of the Fig. 3306 are based on those of PSA to facilitate non-interference one-to-one replacement. Pins, clamps, pivot mounts, extension pieces, and rear brackets used with PSA snubbers are compatible with the Fig. 3306 and can be utilized.
Stroke (in)
4 2 1 2 4, 8 5, 10 6, 12 6
Max Load *
350 650 1,500 6,000 15,000 50,000
New installations: For new installations, the Fig. 3306 is available with
a complete line of pipe clamps and rear brackets.
1 3 10 35
* Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization.
PH 184
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Hydraulic Snubber
Ordering: Specify Fig. No. Size Stroke Load Cold and hot piston settings W dimension when specifying Fig. 3307 Pipe clamp size when specifying option 3 Attachment surface coating Option
Fig. 3306 & 3307 Options Option Consists of
Fig 3306: Basic unit (snubber) with pivot mount and one rear bracket. Fig. 3307: Basic unit with extension piece and one rear bracket. Option 0 plus cylinder eye and additional rear bracket. Option 0 plus cylinder eye and pipe clamp.
2 3
PH 185
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Fig. 3306 Fig. 3307: With Extension Piece Hydraulic Shock and Sway Suppressor (cont.)
X A B R L P SIZE 35 FEMALE THREAD H FOR SIZES 3 - 35 MALE THREAD FOR SIZES 1/4 - 1 DEPTH G
PISTON SETTING
D
Z X
R OPTION 1
A OPTION 2
D1
10
S C L
K DIA.
T OPTION 3
PH 186
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Hydraulic Snubber (cont.)
C A B Min
9.0 1.00 1.19 7.5 1.62 1.56 8.75 10.0 4.00 1.75 3.00 0.38 11.0 13.00 15.0 15.5 19.50 23.5 14.5 17.00 19.5 20.5 25.50 30.5 17.1 20.10 23.1 24.1 30.10 36.1 24.0 27.00 30.0
Mid Max
11.00 13.0
D1
K Dia
2.25
L Dia
2.25
M Dia
1.31
Q Ref
1.19
R Max
0.63
T Dia
0.374 0.372 0.499 0.497 0.749 0.747
W Min
8.25 8.25 8.81 N/A 9.31 N/A
2.00
1.25
2.94
0.38
38-16
0.25
0.62
0.63
38-16
3.25
2.38
1.31
0.38
0.69
2.00
1.00
1.00
2.12
2.12
5.00
3.62
4.50
0.72
58-18
4.62
4.62
2.38
0.50
1.44
2.12
1.38
1.38
10 35
3.00 4.62
3.06 3.00
7.00 9.75
4.00 6.50
5.12 7.75
1.00
1-14
5.75
5.75 6.00
2.88 4.50
1.00 1.25
1.62
2.00 3.00
1.62 2.79
1.38 2.00
1.88 178-12
&
12
3
x 2 1 2 x 2 1 2 1 2 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 3 3 4 x 3 3 4 x 4 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 6 3 4 x 7
1 2 1 2 5 8 5 8
10
x 2 1 2 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 3 4 x 3 3 4 x 4 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 6 1x5 1x5 1x5 1x6 1x7 1x7 1x7 1x7
35
1x7 1 1 4 x 6 1 1 4 x 6 1 1 4 x 7 1 1 4 x 8 1 1 4 x 9 1 1 2 x 8 1 1 2 x 9 112 x 10 112 x 10
316 x 1 2916 316 x 1 1 1 4 21116 1 4 x 1 1 4 4 1 8 1 1 2 1 4 x 1 1 4 2 5 1 8 1 2 3 8 1 4 x 1 1 4 3 8 x 1 3 4 7 7 7 2 5 1 4 x 1 1 4 3 8 x 1 3 4 3 7 7 51516 8 1 8 1 2 316 1 8 1 4 x 1 1 4 3 8 x 1 3 4 7 7 3 6 8 1 2 1 4 1 4 3 8 516 x 2 1 2 x 1 1 2 4 6 7 7 8 516 x 2 1 2 x 1 1 2 5 7 3 4 7 3 4 7 3 4 9 1 8 3 8 3 8 3 8 516 x 2 1 2 x 2 10 6 8 8 8 1 2 x 2 1 2 516 x 2 8 9 3 8 9 3 8 9 3 8 1114 1258 5 8 x 2 1 2 516 x 2 10 1012 1012 1012 1234 1414 5 8 x 2 1 2 12 1178 1178 1378 1538 5 8 x 2 1 2 14 16 1258 1258 1412 5 8 x 3 16 1358 1514 1718 1358 3 4 x 3 18 1458 1458 1638 1814 3 4 x 3 20 1534 1534 1734 1914 3 4 x 4 24 1818 1978 2134 1818 3 4 x 4 30 23 25 2114 2114 1 2 1 8 3 4 x 5 36 24 24 26 28 * Intermediate sizes between 20 and 36 are available and will have the take out and stock of the next larger size. 1
2716
316 x 1
PH 187
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Fig. 200, Fig. C-200 Fig. 201, Fig. C-201: With Extension Piece
Size Range: Seven standard sizes with cylinder bores of 112" to 8" and
with normal load ratings from 3,000 pounds to 128,000 pounds. All are available with 5", 10", 15", or 20" strokes except the 112" size which is offered with 5" and 10" strokes only. Snubbers are available with integral or remote reservoirs.
Hydraulic Snubber
Factory calibrated valves Rapid, positive valve closure Special design minimizes the lost motion which results
from the shifting and seating of piston seals
Max Load *
3,000 1,250 12,500 10,500 21,000 32,000 50,000 72,000 128,000
Unlocked resisting force is less than 1% of rated load Stable, non-ammable, long life hydraulic uid made
highly visible for ease of inspection
Choice of coating
(paint, primer, carbo zinc, epoxy, plating or other)
* Loads must not be applied outside a 10 included angle cone of action to the pipe clamp axis without special authorization.
PH 188
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Hydraulic Snubber (cont.)
Ordering:
Ordering: Specify part number as follows:
XXX X X X X X X X
Reservoir Orientation O=Does not apply for pressurized or remote U=Rod up D=Rod down or horizontal Reservoir Type L=Transparent (Polycarbonate) M=Metal P=Pressurized R=Remote Valve Type A=Adjustable T=Temperature Compensating Option (0,1,2, or 3), See Option Table Below Stroke (5, 10, 15, 20) Cylinder Size: 1 (112 Cyl.) 2 (212 Cyl.) 3 (314 Cyl.) 4 (4Cyl.) 5 (5Cyl.) 6 (6Cyl.) 8 (8 Cyl.) Figure No. (200 or 201), Also Specify: W Dimension when Specifying Fig 201 Pipe Clamp Size when Specifying Option 3 Surface Coating Cold and Hot Piston Settings.
How to size:
(1) Cylinder size: Use table on page PH-191 to select cylinder bore size large enough to restrain expected load. (2) Stroke: Dene expected movement of the pivot joining the suppressor with the equipment to be protected (cold to hot plus any abnormal movements). Determine maximum and minimum distances between this curve and the xed pivot pin of the snubber. The minimum recommended stroke is 20% greater than the difference between these lengths. Note: If erected position at the snubbers location on the equipment is outside of the range of normal cold-to-hot movement (e.g. cold pull of pipe), the snubber should not be installed until after the equipment is in its cold position. This eliminates the need of providing for the extra travel in the snubbers stroke. For 212" through 8" snubbers, standard strokes are 5", 10", 15", and 20". For the 112" snubber, 5" and 10" are the only standard strokes. (3) Installed piston setting: As indicated previously, the snubber should be installed at its cold piston position if possible. From the installed position, take extension (outward movement) of the piston rod as positive (+) and retraction as negative (-). (4) Installed piston position =
1 2 3
PH 189
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Fig. 200, Fig. 201
VENT PORT L K A I X
FIG. 200 HYDRAULIC SHOCK & SWAY SUPPRESSOR SIZE COLD P.S. STROKE HOT P.S. SERIAL NO. CUSTOMERS MARK NO
U.S. PATENT NO 3106992
B R
PISTON SETTING
SECTION X-X
T
FIG. 200 HYDRAULIC SHOCK & SWAY SUPPRESSOR SIZE COLD P.S. STROKE HOT P.S.
OPTION 1
OPTION 2
Q 10
C L
OPTION 3
PH 190
Return to TOC
HYDRAULIC SNUBBER
Hydraulic Snubber (cont.)
Fig 200, 201: Weight (lbs) Dimensions (in)
Cylinder
W L N Q R S T Min Max
9 1 2 7558 6558 94916 84916 74916 64916 92 3 3 4 2 1 4
3 4
2 1 2 1 5 8
2 3 8
3 4
5818
2 3 4 2 1 4
5 8
2 1 8 1 1 8
3 4
5 8
2 1 2 2 1 4
278 7316
7 8
7814
6 1 4
5 1 8
3 1 4 1 3 4
3 4
1 5 8
1 3 8
1038
5 3 4
82 72 62 89916 79916 69916 59916 861316 761316 661316 561316 831516 731516 631516 531516 7512 6512 5512 4512
1 1 8
2 1 2 1 1 4 3 3 8 2 1 2
112 1112
1 1 8
4 1 2
8 1 2
4 3 4 3 1 4 1 3 4
12
1 7 8
1934 2214 2434 5 3 4 5 1 2 2434 2934 3434 2934 3714 4434 3434 4434 5434 2312 26 2812 6 2812 3312 3312 41 3812 4812 14 834 1412 4 312 1212 918 614 11516 214 9116 7 5 8 5 1 4 3 7 8 2 4 5 8 3 1 2 2 3 4 2 1338
1 3 4
not available
4 7 8 4 7 8 2 1 4 6 3 4 4 3 4
212 1412
2 1 4
Fig 200, 201: Dimensions (in) E-Take Out Pipe Size 112
2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36 6 7 7 7 7 1 4 7 3 4 8 3 8 9 3 8 1012 1178 1258 1358 1458 1534 1818 2114 24
314
9 1 8 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
4
10 10 1114 1234 1378 1412 1514 1638 1734 1978 23 2612
6
1914 2134 25 2818
112
3 8 x 1 3 4 3 8 x 1 3 4 3 8 x 1 3 4 3 8 x 1 3 4 1 2 1 2
212
x x 2 1 2 1 2 x 2 1 2 1 2 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 3 3 4 x 3 3 4 x 4 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 5 3 4 x 6 1x5 1x5 1x5 1x6 1x7
1 2 1 2
314
3 4 3 4
4
3 4 3 4
5
1x5 1x6 1x7 1x7 1 1 4 x 6 1 1 4 x 6 1 1 4 x 7 1 1 4 x 8 1 1 4 x 9 1 1 2 x 8 112 x 10
6
1 1 2 x 8 1 1 2 x 9 134 x 10 134 x 10
2 1 2
x 1 1 2 x 1 1 2 1 2 x 2 1 2 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 2 1 2 5 8 x 3 3 4 x 3 3 4 x 3 3 4 x 4 3 4 x 4 3 4 x 5
1 1 4 x 6 1 1 4 x 6
1 1 4 x 6 1 1 4 x 6 1 1 4 x 8 1 1 4 x 9
PH 191
Return to TOC
Tapered Pin
How to size: Select size consistent with load pin diameter for Fig. 200/201 or Fig. 306/307. Features: Designed to sharply reduce the time necessary to remove a badly corroded conventional
pin and may also eliminate damage to the bushing and bracket assembly, particularly if the pin and bracket are corroded.
Minimizes free play between pin to pin. Ordering: Specify gure number, nominal pin size and name. Installation: Shipped assembled. Remove cotter pin, slotted hex nut and washer. Loosen
sleeve on pin and install sleeve/pin. Re-install washer and slotted hex nut. Tighten hex nut to snug. Install cotter pin.
L (REF)
T (NOMINAL)
Compatible With Max Load 650 1,500 6,000 15,000 21,000 50,000 50,000 72,000 128,000 L Fig. 200/201 13 4 2
3 8
Fig. 306/307
14
112
2 1 2
&12 1 3
1 11 4 11 2 13 4 2
2 1 2
3 7 8 43 8 43 4 71 4 7 81 4 93 8
314 4 5 6 8
10 35 100
PH 192
Return to TOC
Fig. 38 SD
This products is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order.
C L
Fig. 53 SD
This products is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order.
v
A
Fig. 71 SD
This products is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order. The Anvil Fig. 71 horizontal traveler facilitates the supporting of piping systems subject to linear horizontal movements were head room is limited. Designed for use with Anvil Variable Spring Hangers or Constant Supports it can also be used in conjunction with a rigid type hanger assembly.
PH 193
v
v
Hole Diam.
v
v
Return to TOC
Fig. 75 SD
This products is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order. Pipe sizes 4 through 42
C OF PIPE L
Fig. 76 SD
This products is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order.
Fig. 76SD: Loads (lbs) Dimensions (in) Max A B C D Load
60,000 2314 26 281516 3078 3118 32 3478 3734 40916 4338 1358 8316 81316 91516 101516 11716 1278 1314 14516 1578 1612 1758
312
Size
30 36 42 46 46 48 54 60 66 72
E
0 1 2 2716 114 11116 234 31516 5 6116
C E 4316 C
v
C L OF PIPE
60,000
1614
101316
1 v
v
v v
PH 194
Return to TOC
Fig. 77SD
This products is a special design per customer requirements. Contact Anvil Intl. for further information and how to order.
Fig. 40 SD
Material: Carbon steel chrome molybdenum or stainless steel. Finish: Plain or Galvanized Maximum Temperature: As required. Ordering: Specify gure number 40SD, riser clamp special
design, material, exact pipe size, load, operating temperature, insulation thickness, C-C dimension, rod diameter, nish and if connected to a spring or rigid connection.
v v v
S
Riser Clamp
Special Design Products
C L
v
v K v
Service: Riser clamps are used for the support of vertical piping.
Load is carried by shear lugs which are welded to the pipe. Shear lugs not provided.
v A
A*
C to C
v
v
v
v
v
PIPE SPACER
A*
PH 195
Return to TOC
Fig. 42 SD
pipe size, load, temperature and nish. Alloy clamps, unless otherwise specied, will be furnished with alloy studs made from ASTM. A-193-B7 stud stock and ASTM A-194-Gr. 2H hex nuts.
A v
E
PH 196
C L
C L
Return to TOC
C-C (NEEDED)
80 V TYPE C
140, 146
140, 146
80 V TYPE G 140, 146 290 224, 246 290 295, 295A, 295H
60
PH 197
Application Examples
Return to TOC
66 81-H TYPE B
66 81-H TYPE B
140, 146 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 299 53-SD WELD LUG 290 295, 295A, 295H 140, 146
ELBOW
81-H TYPE D
81 H TYPE F ELBOW
PH 198
Return to TOC
60
140, 146 66 290 140, 146 82, 268, 98 TYPE A 66 290 C-C (NEEDED) 140, 146 82, 268, 98 TYPE A
140, 146
40 ELBOW ELBOW
66
140, 146 140, 146 299 290 295, 295A, 295H 53-SD WELD LUG
ELBOW
PH 199
Application Examples
Return to TOC
55L
55L 291
140, 146 140, 146 299 53-SD WELD LUG 290 295, 295A, 295H
ELBOW ELBOW
PIPE STANCHION 63 PIPE SLIDE 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 82, 268, 98 TYPE F 82, 268, 98 TYPE F, WITH PIPE ROLLER
ELBOW
66 290
140, 146 140, 146 82, 268, 98 TYPE F 82, 268, 98 TYPE G 137 S 160-166A
60
PH 200
Return to TOC
66 290
66 290
140, 146
FIG. 230 TURNBUCKLE AND FIG. 253 ROD MAY BE ADDED FOR VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT 140, 146 299 53-SD WELD LUG
ELBOW
60
66
55 LUG 299
55 LUG 299
60
66 290 140, 146 C-C (NEEDED) 230 137S 140, 146 45 BACK/BACK CHANNEL SIZED BY CUSTOMERS TO MEET LOAD REQ. ALTERNATE ORIENTATION OF 137S/PIPE C-C (NEEDED) 45 BACK/BACK CHANNEL SIZED BY CUSTOMERS TO MEET LOAD REQ. 137S 140, 146 ALTERNATE ORIENTATION OF 137S/PIPE
60
60
PH 201
Application Examples
Return to TOC
218 157
218 157
218 157
92, 93, 94
65, CT-65, 260 181 65, 260 65, CT-65, 260 167 167
228, 292
228, 292
228, 292
218 157
HOT SERVICE UP TO 4" INSULATION 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 140, 146 260 140, 146 290 212, 216
140, 146
69, CT-69, 70
60
86
66 290
140, 146 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H 65, CT-65, 260 69, CT-69, 70 140, 146 290 295, 295A, 295H
PH 202
Return to TOC
66 290 140, 146 FIG. 230 TURNBUCKLE AND FIG. 253 ROD MAY BE ADDED FOR VERTICAL ADJUSTMENT 140, 146 65, 260
MEDIUM SERVICE MAX. SERVICE TEMP. 650 FOR PIPE CLAMP 140, 146
260 167
140, 146
65, 260
140, 146
140, 146
140, 146
181 69, CT-69, 70 65, CT-65, 260 160 (1" INSUL.) 161 (112" INSUL.) 162 (2" INSUL.) 163 (212" INSUL.) 164 (3" INSUL.) 165 (4" INSUL.)
167
PH 203
Application Examples
Return to TOC
140, 146 160 (1" INSULATION) 161 (112" INSULATION) 162 (2" INSULATION) 163 (212" INSULATION) 164 (3" INSULATION) 165 (4" INSULATION)
160 (1" INSULATION) 161 (112" INSULATION) 162 (2" INSULATION) 163 (212" INSULATION) 164 (3" INSULATION) 165 (4" INSULATION)
140, 146
271 171
171
140, 146
175
177
271
PH 204
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
2.DESIGN
(k) Constant Supports shall be furnished with travel stops which shall prevent upward and downward movement of the hanger. The travel stops will be factory installed so that the hanger level is at the cold position. The travel stops will be of such design as to permit future re-engagement, even in the event the lever is at a position other than cold, without having to make hanger adjustments. (l) For non-critical, low temperature systems, where vertical movements up to 2" are anticipated, an approved precompressed Variable Spring design similar to Anvil Fig. B268 may be used. Where movements are of a small magnitude, spring hangers similar to Anvil Fig. 82 may be used.
(m) Each Variable Spring shall be individually calibrated at the factory and furnished with travel stops. Spring coils must be square to within 1 to insure proper alignment. Each spring coil must be purchased with a C.M.T.R. and be of domestic manufacture. (n) All rigid rod hangers shall provide a means of vertical adjustment after erection. (o) Where the piping system is subject to shock loads, such as seismic disturbances or thrusts imposed by the actuation of safety valves, hanger design shall include provisions for rigid restraints or shock absorbing devices of approved design, such as Anvil Fig. 200 shock and sway suppressor, or equal.
PH 205
Technical Data
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
A Typical Pipe Hanger Specication
(p) Selection of vibration control devices shall not be part of the standard hanger contract. If vibration is encountered after the piping system is in operation, appropriate vibration control equipment shall be installed. (q) Hanger rods shall be subject to tensile loading only (see Table III). At hanger locations where lateral or axial movement is anticipated, suitable linkage shall be provided to permit swing. (r) Where horizontal piping movements are greater than 1 2 " and where the hanger rod angularly from the vertical is less than or equal to 4 degrees from the cold to hot position of the pipe, the hanger pipe and structural attachments shall be offset in such manner that the rod is vertical in the hot position. When the hanger rod angularity is greater than 4 degrees from vertical, then structural attachment will be offset so that at no point with the rod angularity exceed 4 degrees from vertical. Hangers shall be spaced in accordance with Table 1 and Table 2 on the following page. (see page PH-207)
(cont.)
force subsides. The suppressor shall have a hard surfaced, corrosion resistant piston rod supported by a rod bushings and shall be designed so that it is capable of exerting the required force in tension and compression, utilizing the distance. (y) Paint - Variable Spring and Constant Support units will be furnished painted with Stewart Bros. Green Semi-Gloss Primer (#10947). All other material will receive one shop coat of a red chromate primer meeting the requirements of Federal Specication TT-P-636. For corrosive conditions hangers will be galvanized or painted with carbo-zinc #11. (z) All threads are UNC unless otherwise specied.
(t)
(u) Where practical, riser piping shall be supported independently of the connected horizontal piping. Pipe support attachments to the riser piping shall be riser clamp lugs. Welded attachments shall be of material comparable to that of the pipe, and designed in accordance with governing codes. (v) Supports, guides, and anchors shall be so designed that excessive heat will not be transmitted to the building steel. The temperature of supporting parts shall be based on a temperature gradient of 100F per inch distance from the outside surface of the pipe. (w) Hanger components shall not be used for purposes other than for which they were designed. They shall not be used for rigging and erection purposes. (x) Hydraulic Snubbers - The hydraulic units shall have a temperature stable control valve. The valve shall provide a locking and bleed rate velocity that provides for tamper proof settings. The uid level indicator for exact reading of reservoir uid level in any snubber orientation. The valve device shall offer a minimum amount of resistance to thermal movement. Any shock force shall cause the suppressor valve to close. With the suppressor valve closed the uid ow shall essentially stop, thereby causing the unit to resist and absorb the disturbing forces. After the disturbing forces subside, the suppressor valve shall open again to allow free thermal movement of the piping. The suppressor shall have a means of regulating the amount of movement under shock conditions up to the design load for faulted conditions without release of uid. The suppressor design shall include a uid bleed system to assure continued free thermal movement after the shock
PH 206
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
(cont.)
1 1 7
12
212
12
10 12 14 16 18 20
24 32 42
30 33 34
Max. Span (Ft) Water Service Max. Span (Ft) Vapor Service Recommended Hanger Rod Sizes
7 8
7 9
10 11 12 13 14 16 17 19 22 23 25 27 28 30
9 1 2 1 3 1 4 1 5 1 6 1 7 1 9 2 1 2 4 2 6 3 0 3 2 3 5 3 7 39
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4
7 8
1 1 4 1 1 2 1 1 2 or trapeze
The above spacing and capacities are based on pipe lled with water. Additional valves and ttings increase the load and therefore closer hanger spacing is required. * Many codes and specications state "pipe hangers must be spaced every 10ft. regardless of size." This local specication must be followed.
Table 2: Maximum Horizontal Spacing Between Copper Tubing Supports Nominal Tubing Size (in)
12 34
1 6 8
114 7 9
112 8 10
2 8 11
212 9 13
3 10 14
312 11 15
4 12 16
Max. Span (Ft) Water Service Max. Span (Ft) Vapor Service
5 6
5 7
Note: Spans shown in Tables 1 and 2 do not apply where there are concentrated loads between supports or where temperatures exceed 750F.
Table 3: Load Carrying Capacities of Threaded Hanger Rods. Materials Carbon Steel with Minimum Actual Tensile Strength of 50 Ksi. Rod Diameter (in)
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 1 3 4 2 2 1 4 2 1 2 2 3 4 3 3 1 4 3 1 2 3 3 4 4 4 1 4 4 1 2 4 3 4 5
Standard UNC thread thru 3" diameter and 8-UN-2A thread series for
PH 207
Technical Data
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Thermal Expansion of Pipe Material
10
-0.0187 -0.0127 -0.0058 -0.0044 0.0030 0.0107 0.0191 0.0279 0.0372 0.0470 0.0574 0.0681 0.0792 0.0901 0.1015 0.1121 0.1233
20
-0.0192 -0.0133 -0.0065 -0.0037 0.0038 0.0116 0.0200 0.0288 0.0382 0.0481 0.0584 0.0692 0.0803 0.0912 0.1025 0.1132 0.1244
30
-0.0198 -0.0140 -0.0073 -0.0029 0.0046 0.0124 0.0208 0.0298 0.0391 0.0491 0.0595 0.0703 0.0813 0.0924 0.1036 0.1144 0.1256
40
-0.0203 -0.0146 -0.0080 -0.0022 0.0053 0.0132 0.0217 0.0307 0.0401 0.0501 0.0606 0.0714 0.0824 0.0935 0.1046 0.1155 0.1267
50
-0.0209 -0.0152 -0.0087 -0.0015 0.0061 0.0141 0.0226 0.0316 0.0411 0.0512 0.0617 0.0726 0.0835 0.0946 0.1057 0.1166 0.1278
60
-0.0215 -0.0158 -0.0096 -0.0007 0.0068 0.0149 0.0235 0.0325 0.0421 0.0522 0.0627 0.0737 0.0846 0.0958 0.1068 0.1177 0.1299
70
-0.0220 -0.0163 -0.0103 0 0.0076 0.0157 0.0244 0.0334 0.0431 0.0532 0.0638 0.0748 0.0857 0.0970 0.1078 0.1188 0.1320
80
-0.0225 -0.0169 -0.0109 0.0008 0.0084 0.0165 0.0252 0.0344 0.0440 0.0542 0.0649 0.0759 0.0867 0.0981 0.1089 0.1200 0.1342
90
-0.0230 -0.0174 -0.0116 0.0015 0.0091 0.0174 0.0261 0.0353 0.0450 0.0553 0.0659 0.0770 0.0878 0.0993 0.1099 0.1211 0.1363
Thermal Expansion of Pipe Material (in/ft) Temp F Austenitic Stainless Steels (304, 316, 347) 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
-0.0372 -0.0272 -0.0176 0.0023 0.0135 0.0250 0.0368 0.0489 0.0612 0.0737 0.0867 0.0999 0.1134 0.1270 0.1406 0.1542 0.1678 0.1811 to
-200 -0.0281 -0.0295 -0.0305 -0.0314 -0.0324 -0.0334 -0.0343 -0.0353 -0.0362 -100 -0.0187 -0.0197 -0.0207 -0.0216 -0.0226 -0.0236 -0.0245 -0.0254 -0.0263 0 -0.0078 -0.0089 -0.0100 -0.0112 -0.0123 -0.0134 -0.0145 -0.0155 -0.0166 0 -0.0078 -0.0067 -0.0056 -0.0044 -0.0033 -0.0022 -0.0011 0 0.0012 100 0.0034 0.0045 0.0056 0.0068 0.0079 0.0090 0.0101 0.0112 0.0124 200 0.0146 0.0158 0.0169 0.0181 0.0192 0.0203 0.0215 0.0227 0.0238 300 0.0261 0.0273 0.0285 0.0297 0.0309 0.0321 0.0332 0.0344 0.0356 400 0.0380 0.0392 0.0404 0.0416 0.0428 0.0440 0.0453 0.0465 0.0477 500 0.0501 0.0513 0.0526 0.0538 0.0550 0.0562 0.0575 0.0587 0.0599 600 0.0624 0.0637 0.0649 0.0662 0.0674 0.0687 0.0700 0.0712 0.0725 700 0.0750 0.0763 0.0776 0.0789 0.0802 0.0815 0.0828 0.0841 0.0854 800 0.0880 0.0893 0.0906 0.0920 0.0933 0.0946 0.0959 0.0972 0.0986 900 0.1012 0.1260 0.1039 0.1053 0.1066 0.1080 0.1094 0.1107 0.1121 1,000 0.1148 0.1162 0.1175 0.1189 0.1202 0.1216 0.1229 0.1243 0.1257 1,100 0.1284 0.1298 0.1311 0.1325 0.1338 0.1352 0.1366 0.1379 0.1393 1,200 0.1420 0.1434 0.1447 0.1461 0.1474 0.1488 0.1502 0.1515 0.1529 1,300 0.1556 0.1570 0.1583 0.1597 0.1610 0.1624 0.1638 0.1651 0.1665 1,400 0.1692 0.1704 0.1717 0.1731 0.1744 0.1757 0.1771 0.1784 0.1796 Note: Intersect 10 Degree increments across the top of each table with the 100 degree increments down the left side determine the coefcient of thermal expansion for the desired temperature.
PH 208
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Beam Dimensions
v Y v Z v v v Y v Z v v v Y v Z v v
American Standard Channels Mean Depth of Weight Flange Thick of Section per Ft., Width Flange lb. Y Z
4.1 3 5.0 6.0 4 5 5.4 7.25 6.7 9.0 8.2 6 10.5 13.0 9.8 7 12.25 14.75 11.5 8 13.75 18.75 13.4 9 15.0 20.0 15.3 10 20.0 25.0 30.0 20.7 12 25.0 30.0 33.9 15 40.0 50.0 42.7 18 45.8 51.9 58.0 138 112 158 158 134 134 178 178 2 218 218 214 214 214 238 212 238 212 258 258 234 278 3 3 3 318 338 312 334 4 4 418 414 0.625 0.625 0.500 0.438 0.438 0.375 0.375 0.375 0.313 0.250
Flange Width
238 212 258 234 3 314 338 358 358 378 4 418 458 5 5 518 514 512 512 558 6 614 614 638 7 714 7 718 714
Flange Width
5 618 514 514 612 612 8 8 818 818 814 814 534 534 534 8 8 8 10 10 1018 1018 1014 1014 612 612 612 8 8 818 10 10 12 12 1218 1218 1218 1214 634 634 634 8 8 8 10 10 1018 1018 1412
Flange Width
1458 1458 1458 1434 7 7 7 7 1 8 7 1 8 1014 1014 1038 1038 7 1 2 7 1 2 7 1 2 7 5 8 7 5 8 11 1118 1118 1114 8 1 4 8 1 4 8 1 4 8 3 8 8 3 8 1214 1238 1238 9 9 9 1 8 1234 1234 1278 10 10 1018 14 1012 1012 1012 1012 1112 1112 1112 12 12 12
0.313 6 7 8 10
0.875
PH 209
Technical Data
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Steel Pipe Data Schedule No 40 & 80
Pipe Size
O.D.
Schedule No.
40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 40 80 20 API
Wall Thick.
0.091 0.126 0.109 0.147 0.113 0.154 0.133 0.179 0.140 0.191 0.145 0.200 0.154 0.218 0.203 0.276 0.216 0.300 0.226 0.318 0.237 0.337 0.258 0.375 0.280 0.432 0.322 0.500 0.365 0.593 0.406 0.687 0.437 0.750 0.500 0.843 0.563 0.937 0.593 1.031 0.687 1.218 0.500 0.500
3 8
0.675 0.840 1.050 1.315 1.660 1.900 2.375 2.875 3.500 4.000 4.500 5.563 6.625 8.625 10.750 12.75 14.000 16.000 18.000 20.000 24.000 30.000 36.000
1 2
3 4
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 24 30 36
PH 210
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
O.D. Tubing
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
O.D.
0.375 0.500 0.625 0.750 0.875 1.125 1.375 1.625 2.125 2.625 3.125 3.625 4.125 5.125 6.125 8.125 10.125 12.125
Wall Thick.
0.030 0.035 0.040 0.042 0.045 0.050 0.055 0.060 0.070 0.080 0.090 0.100 0.110 0.125 0.140 0.200 0.250 0.280
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12
1 1 8 1 3 8 1 5 8 2 1 8 2 5 8 3 1 8 3 5 8 4 1 8 5 1 8 6 1 8 8 1 8 10 1 8 12 1 8
O.D. Tubing
3 8 1 2 5 8 3 4 7 8
O.D.
0.375 0.500 0.625 0.750 0.875 1.125 1.375 1.625 2.125 2.625 3.125 3.625 4.125 5.125 6.125 8.125 10.125 12.125
Wall Thick.
0.035 0.049 0.049 0.049 0.065 0.065 0.065 0.072 0.083 0.095 0.109 0.120 0.134 0.160 0.192 0.271 0.338 0.405
1 1 1 4 1 1 2 2 2 1 2 3 3 1 2 4 5 6 8 10 12
1 1 8 1 3 8 1 5 8 2 1 8 2 5 8 3 1 8 3 5 8 4 1 8 5 1 8 6 1 8 8 1 8 1018 1218
PH 211
Technical Data
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Other Pipe Data
Flange Cast Iron Pipe Add Weight of Flanges * Pipe Size Class O.D. C.I. Pipe Wall Thick. Weight per ft. (lbs) Weight of Water per ft. (lbs). Pipe Size
1 1 2 2 3 4 6
O.D.
3 150 3.96 4 150 4.80 6 150 6.90 8 150 9.05 10 150 11.10 12 150 13.20 14 150 15.30 16 150 17.40 18 150 19.50 20 150 21.60 24 150 25.80 30 150 32.00 36 150 38.30 42 150 44.50 48 150 50.80 * Mechanical joint pipe class ISO weight as Bell & Spigot
0.32 12.2 3.7 0.32 16.4 5.7 0.38 25.7 12.8 0.41 36.7 23.1 0.44 48.7 35.5 0.48 62.9 51.0 0.51 78.8 69.3 0.54 95.0 90.3 0.58 114.7 114.0 0.62 135.9 141.5 0.73 190.4 201.0 0.85 277.3 312.0 0.94 368.9 449.0 1.05 479.1 612.0 1.14 595.2 803.0 is approximately the same
O.D.
Wall Thick.
0.16 0.17 0.17 0.20 0.26 0.33
PH 212
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
FM Pipe Size
212 - 4
34
212 - 4
34
38 12 38
38 12 38 12 58 34 38 12 58 34 38 12 58 34 38 12 38 12 58 34
-4 5-8 -2
-4 5-8 -2
34
34
-2
86
23
23
23
12 58 34 38
212 - 312 4, 5 6
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6
34
-2
-2
-2
87
23
23
23
12 58 34 38
212 - 312 4, 5 6
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6
34
-2
-2
-2
88
23
23
23
12 58 34
212 - 312 4, 5 6
34
19 & 23 19 & 23 19 23 9 9 6 11
23 23 19 23 9 9 6 11
19 & 23 19 & 23 19 23 9 9 6 11
38 12 38 12 58 34
-4 5-8 -4 5-8 10 12
34
38 12 58 34 78
38 12 58
38 12 58
34
-2
-2
38 12
212 - 312 4
34
38 12 58 34 78
212 - 312 4
34
-4 5-8 10 12 12
-4 5-8 10 12 12
110R
16
16
16
58 34 78
15 21 21
15 21 21 24 24 25
15 21 21 24 24 12
38 12 12 58 38 12 58 34 78
38 12 12 58 38 12 58 34 78
34
-4 5-8 5-8
34
-4 5-8 5-8
10 - 12
34
10 - 12
34
-2 312
-2 312
-2
136
6 8
6 8
6 8
24 24 12
PH 213
Technical Data
212
4, 5
212
4, 5
212
- 312 4, 5
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Anvil Compliances and Approvals
Product Types Anvil Figure Number MSS-SP-58 & MSS-SP-69 WW-H-171-E
152 153 157 160 161 162 163 164 165 165A 166A 167 168 171 175 177 178 181 191 192 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 39A & 39B 40 40 41 44 41 49 43 37 38 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 40A & 40B 41 41 42 45 42 50 44 38 39
(cont.)
Application Sizes FM Rod Size
38 12 58 34 78 38 12 58 34 78 38 12 58 34 78
FM Pipe Size
34
UL Rod Size
38 12 58 34 78 38 12 58 34 78 38 12 58 34 78
UL Pipe Size
34
-2
-2
-2
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
-2
-2
-2
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
-2 312
-2 - 312
38 12 58
212
212
4, 5 6 8
34
4, 5 6 8
34
38 12
38 12 58 38 12 58 38 12 38 12 58 34 78
-2
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
194
31
32
31
58 34 78
32 33 34
33 34 35
32 33 34
38 12 58 38
-2
-2
-2
212 - 312 4, 5
34
212 - 312 4, 5
34
212 - 312 4, 5
34
-4
-4
38 12 58 34 78
206
34
35
34
12 58
5, 6 8
34
5, 6 8
34
207
34
35
34
38
-4 -2
-4 -2
38 12
34
5-8
34
-2
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
212
58 34 78
PH 214
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
(cont.)
FM Pipe Size
34
34
-2
-2
-2
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
218
30
30
30
58 34 78
224 227 228 228L 230 233 246 257 258 259
2 25 28 & 29 28 & 29 13 13 2 35 36 37
2 25 28 & 29 28 & 29 13 13 2 35 36 37
38 12
38 12
38 12 58 34 78
-2
-2
212 - 8
34
212 - 8
34
38 12
38 12 58 34 78
-2
-2
-2
212 - 312 4, 5 6 8
34
260
58 34 78
8 26 38 38 44 46 45
8 26 39 39 45 47 46
8 26 38 38 44 46 45
38
N/A
38 12 58 34 38 12 58 34 78 38 12 58
N/A
38 12 58 34 38 12 58 34 78 38 12 58
-4
-4
-4
281
18
19
18
12 58 34 38 12
-4
-4
-4
282
18
18
18
58 34 78 38
-4
-4
34
-4
19 18 17 17
18 18 17 17
18 18 17 17
12 58
5-8 8 MAX.
5-8 8 MAX.
5-8 8 MAX.
PH 215
Technical Data
8 MAX.
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Anvil Compliances and Approvals
Product Types Anvil Figure Number
292 292L 295 295A 295H 299 300 436 439 590 595 600 CT-65 CT-69 CT-99 CT-99C CT-109 CT-121 CT-138R
(cont.)
FM Rod Size
FM Pipe Size
UL UL ULC ULC Rod Size Pipe Size Rod Size Pipe Size
A type is dependent upon its appropriate installation and use. Note: Figure 218 Must be used with Figure 157.
Engineered Hangers - Approval Listings Product Types Anvil Figure Number MSS-SP-58 & MSS-SP-69
48 50 47 47
A-A-1192A
49 55 -
247 - Spring Cushion 296, 297 & 302 - Swing Sway Brace 200, 201 - Hydraulic Snubbers 3306 & 3307 - Hydraulic Snubbers Variable Spring Hangers 82, B-268, 98, Triple, Quadruple Type A-E 82, B-268, 98, Triple, Quadruple Type F 82, B-268, 98, Triple, Quadruple Type G Constant Support Hangers 80-V Type A-E 80-V Type G 81-H Type A-E
51 52 53
51 56 57
51 56 57
55 56 54
58 59 52
58 59 52
PH 216
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Anvil Pipe Hangers and Support Services Pipe Hanger & Support
Hardware Hangers Complete Product Line of:
Carbon Steel, Stainless Steel Cast Iron, Malleable Iron Copper & PVC Coated Plain, Galvanized & Painted Engineered Hangers Variable Springs Constant Supports Hydraulic Snubbers Vibration Sway Braces Sway Struts Limit Stops Special Structural Steel, Fabrication/Miscellaneous
National Fire Protection Association (NFPA) ASME Boiler and Pressure Vessel Code
B31.1 Power Piping B31.3 Chemical Plant and Petroleum Renery Piping B31.9 Building Services Piping MIL Spec P-15877 Marine Hangers Support walk downs and verication QA/QC services for on site or off site work Support adjustments and materials QA inspection and verication Integrity Analysis Non-destructive Testing Training Programs Nuclear services geared to nuclear power market include: Section XI Services Compliance with NRC directives involving piping systems and components Accredited by and granted an NPT & "NS" Nuclear Certicate of Authorization Quality activities audited by NUPIC and various individual utilities Commercial grade dedication program.
Special Design Products per Customer Specications Domestic Manufactured Product Line
FIELD SERVICES:
Anvil Markets
Fire Protection Mechanical HVAC/Plumbing Industrial Petro Chemical Renery Pulp & Paper Waste Water, Water Treatment Marine Co-generation Fossil Power Nuclear Power Seismic
Technical Services
Design services, either on or off site, help you
maximize the efciency of your pipe support systems. These services include: Pipe Hanger design and engineering
Drafting Services System Analysis Pipe Stress Analysis Product Qualication Testing Supervision of client design personnel HYDRAULIC SNUBBERS: The Pipe Support Division has the technical expertise, manufacturing facilities and testing equipment to provide extensive design, installation, maintenance and repair or rebuild services for hydraulic shock suppressors. On site service available by certied technicians for fossil and nuclear plants.
PH 217
Technical Data
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Anvil Terms of Sale and Conditions
1. CONTROLLING PROVISIONS:
These terms and conditions shall control with respect to any purchase order or sale of Seller's products. No waiver, alteration or modication of these terms and conditions whether on Buyer's purchase order or otherwise shall be valid unless the waiver, alteration or modication is specically accepted in writing and signed by an authorized representative of Seller.
6. SHIPMENTS:
All products sent out will be carefully examined, counted and packed. The cost of any special packing or special handling caused by Buyer's requirements or requests shall be added to the amount of the order. No claim for shortages will be allowed unless make in writing within ten (10) days of receipt of a shipment. Claims for products damaged or lost in transit should be made on the carrier, as Seller's responsibility ceases, and title passes, on delivery to the carrier.
2. DELIVERY:
Seller will make every effort to complete delivery of products as indicated on Seller's acceptance of an order, but Seller assumes no responsibility or liability, and will accept no back charge, for loss or damage due to delay or inability to deliver caused by acts of God, war, labor difculties, accident, delays of carriers, by contractors or suppliers, inability to obtain materials, shortages of fuel and energy, or any other causes of any kind whatever beyond the control of Seller. Seller may terminate any contract of sale of its products without liability of any nature, by written notice to Buyer, in the event that the delay in delivery or performance resulting from any of the aforesaid causes shall continue for a period of sixty (60) days. Under no circumstances shall Seller be liable for any special or consequential damages or for loss, damage, or expense (whether or not based on negligence) directly or indirectly arising from delays or failure to give notice of delay.
7. SPECIAL PRODUCTS:
Orders covering special or nonstandard products are not subject to cancellation except on such terms as Seller may specify on application.
9.TAXES:
The amount of any sales, excise or other taxes, if any, applicable to the products covered by this order, shall be paid by Buyer unless Buyer provides Seller with an exemption certicate acceptable to the taxing authorities.
3. WARRANTY:
Seller warrants for one year from the date of shipment Seller's manufactured products to the extent that Seller will replace those having defects in material or workmanship when used for the purpose and in the manner which Seller recommends. If Seller examination shall disclose to its satisfaction that the products are defective, and an adjustment is required, the amount of such adjustment shall not exceed the net sales price of the defective products and no allowance will be made for labor or expense of repairing or replacing defective products or workmanship of damage resulting from the same. Seller warrants the products which it sells of other manufacturers to the extent of the warranties of their respective makers. Where engineering design or fabrication work is supplied. Buyer's acceptance of Seller's design or of delivery of work shall relieve Seller of all further obligation, other than expressed in Seller's product warranty. THIS IS SELLER'S SOLE WARRANTY. SELLER MAKES NO OTHER WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED AND ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE WHICH EXCEED SELLER'S AFORESTATED OBLIGATION ARE HEREBY DISCLAIMED BY SELLER AND EXCLUDED FROM THIS WARRANTY. Seller neither assumes, nor authorizes any person to assume for it, any other obligation in connection with the sale of its engineering designs or products. This warranty shall not apply to any products or parts of products which (a) have been repaired or altered outside of Seller's factory, in any manner; (b) have been subjected to misuse, negligence or accidents; (c) have been used in a manner contrary to Seller's instructions or recommendations. Seller shall not be responsible for design errors due to inaccurate or incomplete information supplied by Buyer or its representatives.
12. TERMS:
Cash, net 30 days unless otherwise specied. NOTE: All orders are accepted on the basis of prices in effect at the time of shipment.
NOTICE:
The prices and terms quoted, there will be added any manufacturers or sales tax payable on the transaction under any effective statute.
FREIGHT ALLOWANCE:
All prices are F.O.B. point of shipment. On (non-engineered product) shipments of 2,500 pounds or more, rail freight or motor freight at the lowest published rates is allowed to all continental U.S. rail points or all U.S. highway points listed in published tariffs (Alaska and Hawaii excluded). In no case will more than actual freight be allowed.
4.SELLER'S LIABILITY:
Seller will not be liable for any loss, damage, cost of repairs, incidental or consequential damages of any kind, whether based upon warranty (except for the obligation accepted by Seller under "Warranty" above), contract or negligence, arising in connection with the design, manufacture, sale, use or repair of the products or of the engineering designs supplied to Buyer
EXCEPTIONS:
All Constant Supports, Spring Hangers, Sway Braces and all Engineered, Bundled and Tagged Hanger Assemblies are F.O.B. Plants, with No Freight Allowed.
5.RETURNS:
Seller cannot accept return of any products unless its written permission has been rst obtained, in which case same will be credited subject to the following: (a) all material returned must, on its arrival at Seller's Plant, be found to be in rst-class condition; if not, cost of putting in saleable condition will be deducted from credit memoranda; (b) a handling charge deduction of twenty percent (20%) will be made from all credit memoranda issued for material returned; and (c) transportation charges, if not prepaid will be deducted from credit memoranda.
PH 218
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
PH 219
Technical Data
Return to TOC
ELECTRONIC COMMERCE BROCHURE (EC 8.01) Order Document Number 003 PIPE FITTINGS CATALOG (PF-11.01) Order Document Number 010
Return to TOC
HVAC PIPING PRODUCTS BROCHURE (HVAC 12.01) Order Document Number 049
FIRE PROTECTION PRODUCTS BROCHURE (FP 11.01) Order Document Number 038
DESIGN SERVICES BROCHURE Order Document Number 105 ANVIL INTERACTIVE CD Order Document Number 899
Gruvlok Interactive Catalog Gruvlok Submittal Package Gruvlok Fire Protection Brochure Gruvlok HVAC & Mining Brochure Interactive Pipe Fittings Catalog Pipe Fitters Handbook Anvil List Price Sheets Design Services Brochure Technical & Engineering Data Contact Information
Return to TOC
WESTERN REGION
Regional Service Center: Servicing Alaska, Arizona, California, Hawaii, Idaho, Montana, Nevada, Oregon, Utah, Washington
1385 Greg Street Sparks, NV 89431 Tel: 775-353-7366 Fax: 775-331-2810 Shipping/Receiving Fax: 775-331-3645 Bob Arison Regional Vice President Sales Office 1600 Sacramento Inn Way, Suite 202 Sacramento, CA 95815 Tel: 916-641-0166 Fax: 916-641-0560 Satellite Offices P.O. Box 10206 Portland, OR 97210 Tel: 503-223-7101 Fax: 503-223-7130 23285 A Eichler Street Hayward, CA 94545-2750 Tel: 510-887-8700 Fax: 510-887-6815 14103 Borate St. Sante Fe Springs, CA 90670 Tel: 562-802-7459 Fax: 562-802-7519 8212 S. 196th Street Kent, WA 98032 Tel: 425-251-9585 Fax: 425-251-5489
1313 Avenue R Grand Prairie, TX 75050 Tel: 972-343-9206 Fax: 972-641-8946 Bob Arison Regional Vice President Satellite Offices 6999 Old Clinton Rd Houston, TX 77020 Tel: 713-675-6371 Fax: 713-678-7858 2600 W. 42nd Street Odessa, TX 79764 Tel: 915-366-2803 Fax: 915-366-0890 3131 W. Thomas Road Phoenix, AZ 85017 Tel: 602-272-6535 Fax: 602-278-3792 4200 Holly Street Denver, CO 80216 Tel: 303-394-2178 Fax: 303-321-3050
Return to TOC
750 Central Avenue University Park, IL 60466 Tel: 708-534-1414 Fax: 708-534-5441 Toll Free: 1-800-301-2701 Dean Taylor Regional Vice President SALES OFFICE 321 North Point Drive Pittsburgh, PA 15233 Tel: 412-321-6544 Fax: 412-321-6643 Toll Free: 1-800-441-1352 SATELLITE OFFICES 1201 W. 96th Street Bloomington, MN 55431 Tel: 952-884-7131 Fax: 952-887-1501 Toll Free: 1-800-733-7131 9530 Le Saint Drive Fairfield, OH 45014 Tel: 513-682-2330 Fax: 513-870-0109 Toll Free: 1-800-837-2424 8615 East 33rd Street Indianapolis, IN 46226 Tel: 317-895-2424 Fax: 317-895-2430 Toll Free: 1-800-837-1515 1930 Warren Street Kansas City, MO 64116 Tel: 816-474-0500 Fax: 816-221-7150 Toll Free: 1-800-877-7007 24600 Northline Taylor, MI 48180 Tel: 313-292-3800 Fax: 313-292-1821 Toll Free: 1-800-279-1601
2530 Pearl Buck Road Bristol, PA 19007 Tel: 215-788-4056 Fax: 215-788-4475 Tom Ward Regional Vice President Sales Offices 792 S. Main Street Mansfield, MA 02048 Tel: 508-261-4050 Fax: 508-261-4046 1234 Route 23 North Butler, NJ 07405 Tel: 973-696-0600 Fax: 973-696-5124
6344 Cash Court Norcross, GA 30071 Tel: 770-662-8177 Fax: 770-662-0284 Tom Ward Regional Vice President Sales Office 1202 Tech Blvd., Suite 103 Tampa, FL 33619 Tel: 800-429-0703 Fax: 813-663-0811
Return to TOC
Today, Mueller Flow Control is the number one distributor of PVF and fire protection products in Canada.
PRODUCTS RIGHT WHEN YOU NEED THEM. Mueller Flow Control carries thousands of combinations and styles of valves, pipe and fittings along with a premier line of fire protection sprinklers and related equipment. With this comprehensive product lineup, Mueller Flow Control can continuously meet the needs of the industrial, commercial, fire protection markets. This extensive North American inventory is readily available to you...right now.
Prince George
Edmonton Delta Calgary Vancouver City Nanaimo Regina Winnepeg Montreal Sudbury Ste Foy Saskatoon
Toronto
Sarnia
Stoney Creek
CORPORATE OFFICES
470 Seaman Street Stoney Creek, ON L8E 2V9 PH: (905) 664-1459 FAX: (905) 664-3190 Kevin Fullan Vice President kfullan@muellerflow.com Doug Crawford National Marketing Manager dcrawford@muellerflow.com
BRITISH COLUMBIA
Distribution Centre 7168 Progress Way Delta, B.C. V4G 1H2 PH: (604) 940-1449 (800) 663-4263 FAX: (604) 940-9878 delta@muellerflow.com 2560 Kenworth Road Nanaimo, B.C. V9T 3Y4 PH: (250) 758-1551 (800) 560-1651 FAX: (250) 758-1160 nanaimo@mullerflow.com 381 Unit B McAloney Cres. Prince George, B.C. V2K 4L2 PH: (250) 561-1219 (800) 210-5672 FAX: (250) 561-7358 prgeorge@muellerflow.com 125 West 2nd Avenue Vancouver, B.C. V5Y 1B8 PH: (604) 875-6990 FAX: (604) 875-6962 vancouver@muellerflow.com
MANITOBA
Distribution Centre 777 Century Street Winnipeg, MB R3H 0M2 PH: (204) 774-3461 (800) 656-6125 FAX: (204) 786-5044 winnipeg@muellerflow.com
QUEBEC
Distribution Centre 3980 Jean Talon Street West Montreal, QU H4P 1V6 PH: (514) 342-2100 (800) 361-9311 FAX: (514) 342-2177 Montreal@muellerflow.com 2655 Dalton Street Ste Foy, QU G1P 3S8 PH: (418) 650-5766 (888) 340-3086 FAX: (418) 653-2205 Stefoy@muellerflow.com
ONTARIO
Distribution Centre 470 Seaman Street Stoney Creek, ON L8E 2V9 PH: (905) 664-9230 (800) 268-0360 FAX: (905) 664-9556 (800) 817-4631 stoney@muellerflow.com Toronto PH: 416-251-4171 FAX: 416-251-7087 211 Campbell Street Sarnia, ON N7T 2G6 PH: (519) 336-7690 (800) 265-7508 FAX: (519) 336-1621 Sarnia@muellerflow.com 1275 Kelly Lake Road Sudbury, ON P3E 5P5 PH: (705) 675-2111 (800) 397-8708 FAX: (705) 675-5725 (800) 289-0264 Sudbury@muellerflow.com
ALBERTA
Calgary PH: 403-246-0033 FAX: 403-246-0051 Distribution Centre 11340 120th Street Edmonton, AB T5G 0W5 PH: (780) 452-9841 (800) 663-1248 FAX: (780) 452-9873 edmonton@muellerflow.com
SASKATCHEWAN
285 Mill Street Regina, SK S4P 3W7 PH: (306) 543-5536 (800) 667-7707 FAX: (306) 545-0390 regina@muellerflow.com Saskatoon Tel: 306-242-6788 Fax: 306-242-5089
Return to TOC
Subject Index
Table of Contents Photo Index C o p p e r Tu b i n g H a n g e r s Pipe Rings Clevis Steel Pipe Clamps Socket Clamps Beam Clamps Structural Attachments Brackets Ceiling Plates Concrete Inserts & Attachments Hanger Rods Rod Attachments Bolts Nuts & Pins U-Bolts Straps Pipe Supports Tr a p e z e Pipe Shields & Saddles Pipe Rolls Pipe Guide & Slides Spring Hangers Constant Supports Vibration Control & Sway Brace Sway Strut Assembly Snubbers & Limit Stops Special Design Products Te c h n i c a l D a t a 4 - 5 6 - 13 14 - 21 22 - 26 27 - 31 32 - 43 44 - 45 46 - 57 58 - 62 63 - 67 68 - 70 71 - 79 80 - 83 84 - 90 91 92 - 93 94 - 95 98 - 97 103 - 105 106 - 111 112 - 119 120 - 130 131 - 149 150 - 174 175 - 177 178 - 182 184 - 183 193 - 196 205 - 227
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Fig. 14 through Fig. 212FP
Figure Number Figure Number
Fig. 14 Fig. 38SD Fig. 40 Fig. 40SD Fig. 41SD Fig. 42SD Fig. 45 Fig. 46 Fig. 47 Fig. 49 Fig. 50 Fig. 52 Fig. 53SD Fig. 54 Fig. 55 & Fig. 55L Fig. 60 Fig. 62 Type A, B & C Fig. 63 Type A, B & C Fig. 65 Fig. 66 Fig. 67 Fig. 69 Fig. 71SD Fig. 72SD Fig. 75SD Fig. 76SD Fig. 77SD Fig. 80-V Type A Fig. 80-V Type B Fig. 80-V Type C Fig. 80-V Type D Fig. 80-V Type E Fig. 80-V Type G Fig. 80-V Type A, B & C Size 84-110 Fig. 81-H Type A Fig. 81-H Type B Fig. 81-H Type C Fig. 81-H Type D Fig. 81-H Type E Fig. 81-H Type F Upthrust Fig. 81-H Type A, B & C Size 84-110 Fig. 80-V and Fig. 81-H - Weight Chart Fig. 82 Fig. 86, Fig. 87 & Fig. 88 Fig. 89 Fig. 89X Fig. 92 Fig. 93 Fig. 94
Page
47 25 132 - 133, 145 35 34 24 22 85 62 62 85 93 94 68 69 54 54 84 84 92 23 81 80 80 83 71 70 86 108 - 111 106 107 174 113 116 112 114 115 98 98 65 66 67 188 - 191 63 64 64 182 178 - 179 36, 130 37
Page
53 193 33 195 196 196 104 103 77 78 105 79 193 59 58 61 96 97 28 60 27 26 193 194 194 194 195 158 159 160 161 162 163 164 165 166 167 168 169 170 171 172 132 - 133, 143 46 48 48 49 50 51
Fig. 95 Fig. 97 & Fig. 97C Fig. 98, Fig. C-98 Series Fig. 100 Fig. 103 Fig. 104 Fig. 108 Fig. 110R Fig. 112 Fig. 113 Fig. 114 Fig. 120 Fig. 126 Fig. 127 Fig. 128 & Fig. 128R Fig. 133 Fig. 134 Fig. 135, Fig. 135E & Fig. 135R Fig. 136 & Fig. 136R Fig. 137, Fig. 137S & Fig. 137C Fig. 138R Fig. 140 Fig. 142 Fig. 146 Fig. 148 Fig. 152 Fig. 153 Fig. 157 Fig. 160 to Fig. 166A Fig. 167 Fig. 168 Fig. 170 Fig. 171 Fig. 175 Fig. 177 Fig. 178 Fig. 181 Fig. 191 Fig. 192 Fig. 194 Fig. 195 Fig. 199 Fig. 200, C-200 Fig. 202 Fig. 206 Fig. 207 Fig. 210 Fig. 211, C-211, Fig. 212 Fig. 212FP
PH 226
Return to TOC
TECHNICAL DATA
Page
38 53 55 180 - 181 42 52 56 88 88 95 95 43 131 81 82 81 120 - 121 122 - 123 125 125 99 102 29 32 94 100 101 137 138 139 140 141 118 119 119 119 117 82 82 73 72 76 74 75 89 90 57 39 40 41 175 - 176
Figure Number
Fig. 297, 298, 302, 303 Fig. 299 Fig. 300 Fig. 312 Fig. 395 Fig. 432 Fig. 436 Fig. 436A Fig. 439 Fig. 590 Fig. 595 & Fig. 594 Fig. 600 & Fig. 599 Fig. 640, C-640 Fig. 1306, 1307 Fig. 3306, 3307 Fig. CT-65 Fig. CT-69 Fig. CT-99 & Fig. CT-99C Fig. CT-109 Fig. CT-121 & Fig. CT-121C Fig. CT-128R Fig. CT-138R Fig. CT-255
Page
177 87 30 192 68 129 125 127 127 31 44 45 178 - 179 183 184 - 187 15 14 16 17 18 19 17 20
Anvil Compliances and Approvals Anvil Pipe Hangers and Support Ser vices Anvil Terms of Sale and Conditions Beam Dimensions Constant Support, Check List Constant Support, Total Travel & Selection Chart Copper Tube Data Hexagon Nuts Machine Bolts Maximum Recommended Applied Torques Model R 80-V, 81-H Mathematically Per fect Pipe Support Other Pipe Data Quadruple Spring, Quadruple Spring-CR Series Spring Hanger Check List Spring Hanger Size & Series Selection Steel Pipe Data Thermal Expansion of Pipe Material Triple Spring, Triple Spring-CR Series Typical Pipe Hanger Specication
213 - 216 217 218 209 173 154 - 157 211 91 91 212 150 - 153 212 132 - 133, 149 136 134 - 135 210 208 132 - 133, 147 205 - 207
PH 227
Technical Data
Return to TOC